10-K 1 d271302d10k.htm FORM 10-K Form 10-K
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

Form 10-K

(Mark One)

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011

or

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from            to            .

Commission file number 1-14315

 

 

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware   76-0127701

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

10943 North Sam Houston Parkway West   77064
(Address of principal executive offices)   (zip code)

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (281) 897-7788

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Each Class

 

Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered

Common Stock, $0.01 par value   New York Stock Exchange

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    ¨  Yes    x  No

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    ¨  Yes    x  No

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer   ¨    Accelerated filer   x
Non-accelerated filer   ¨  (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)    Smaller reporting company   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).    ¨  Yes    x  No

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant on May 1, 2011, was $246,673,518, which aggregate market value was calculated using the closing sales price reported by the New York Stock Exchange as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter.

APPLICABLE ONLY TO CORPORATE ISSUERS

Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the issuer’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.

The number of shares of common stock of the registrant outstanding on December 16, 2011 was 20,556,301.

 

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

Certain information required by Part III of this Annual Report is incorporated by reference from the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for its 2012 annual meeting of shareholders to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days of October 30, 2011.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

PART I

     5   

 Item 1.

 

Business

     5   

 Item 1A.

 

Risk Factors

     22   

 Item 1B.

 

Unresolved Staff Comments

     32   

 Item 2.

 

Properties

     32   

 Item 3.

 

Legal Proceedings

     33   

PART II

     35   

 Item 5.

 

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

     35   

 Item 6.

 

Selected Financial Data

     38   

 Item 7.

 

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

     38   

 Item 7A.

 

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

     66   

 Item 8.

 

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

     69   

 Item 9.

 

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

     128   

 Item 9A.

 

Controls and Procedures

     128   

 Item 9B.

 

Other Information

     128   

PART III

     129   

 Item 10.

 

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

     129   

 Item 11.

 

Executive Compensation

     129   

 Item 12.

 

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

     129   

 Item 13.

 

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

     129   

 Item 14.

 

Principal Accounting Fees and Services

     129   

 Item 15.

 

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

     130   

 

2


Table of Contents

FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report includes statements concerning our expectations, beliefs, plans, objectives, goals, strategies, future events or performance and underlying assumptions and other statements that are not historical facts. These statements are “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Actual results may differ materially from those expressed or implied by these statements. In some cases, our forward-looking statements can be identified by the words “anticipate,” “believe,” “continue,” “could,” “estimate,” “expect,” “forecast,” “goal,” “intend,” “may,” “objective,” “plan,” “potential,” “predict,” “projection,” “should,” “will” or other similar words. We have based our forward-looking statements on our management’s beliefs and assumptions based on information available to our management at the time the statements are made. We caution you that assumptions, beliefs, expectations, intentions and projections about future events may and often do vary materially from actual results. Therefore, we cannot assure you that actual results will not differ materially from those expressed or implied by our forward-looking statements. Accordingly, investors are cautioned not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking information, including any earnings guidance, if applicable. Although we believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable, these expectations and the related statements are subject to risks, uncertainties, and other factors that could cause the actual results to differ materially from those projected. These risks, uncertainties, and other factors include, but are not limited to:

 

   

industry cyclicality and seasonality and adverse weather conditions;

 

   

challenging economic conditions affecting the nonresidential construction industry;

 

   

volatility in the U.S. economy and abroad, generally, and in the credit markets;

 

   

ability to service or refinance our debt and obtain future financing;

 

   

the Company’s ability to comply with the financial tests and covenants in its existing and future debt obligations;

 

   

operational limitations or restrictions in connection with our debt;

 

   

recognition of asset impairment charges;

 

   

commodity price increases and/or limited availability of raw materials, including steel;

 

   

the ability to make strategic acquisitions accretive to earnings;

 

   

retention and replacement of key personnel;

 

   

enforcement and obsolescence of intellectual property rights;

 

   

fluctuations in customer demand;

 

   

costs related to environmental cleanups and liabilities;

 

   

competitive activity and pricing pressure;

 

   

the volatility of the Company’s stock price;

 

   

the substantial rights, seniority and dilutive effect on our common stockholders of the Convertible Preferred Stock issued to investment funds affiliated with Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, LLC;

 

   

breaches of our information security system security measures;

 

   

hazards that may cause personal injury or property damage, thereby subjecting us to liabilities and possible losses, which may not be covered by insurance;

 

   

changes in laws or regulations;

 

   

the cost and other effects, if any, of our offering for sale under our 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan unregistered shares of our Common Stock between March 6, 2006 and February 15, 2011;

 

3


Table of Contents
   

costs and other effects of legal and administrative proceedings, settlements, investigations, claims and other matters; and

 

   

other risks detailed under the caption “Risk Factors” in Item 1A of this report.

A forward-looking statement may include a statement of the assumptions or bases underlying the forward-looking statement. We believe that we have chosen these assumptions or bases in good faith and that they are reasonable. However, we caution you that assumed facts or bases almost always vary from actual results, and the differences between assumed facts or bases and actual results can be material, depending on the circumstances. When considering forward-looking statements, you should keep in mind the risk factors and other cautionary statements in this report, including those described under the caption “Risk Factors” in Item 1A of this report. We expressly disclaim any obligations to release publicly any updates or revisions to these forward-looking statements to reflect any changes in our expectations unless the securities laws require us to do so.

 

4


Table of Contents

PART I

Item 1. Business.

General

NCI Building Systems, Inc. (together with its subsidiaries and predecessors, unless the context requires otherwise, the “Company,” “we,” “us” or “our”) is one of North America’s largest integrated manufacturers and marketers of metal products for the nonresidential construction industry. Of the $150 billion nonresidential construction industry, we primarily serve the low-rise nonresidential construction market (five stories or less) which, according to FW Dodge/McGraw-Hill represented approximately 90% of the total nonresidential construction industry during our fiscal year 2011. Our broad range of products are used in repair, retrofit and new construction activities, primarily in North America.

We provide metal coil coating services for commercial and construction applications, servicing both internal and external customers. We design, engineer, manufacture and market what we believe is one of the most comprehensive lines of metal components and engineered building systems in the industry, with a reputation for high quality and superior engineering and design. We go to market with well-recognized brands, which allow us to compete effectively within a broad range of end-user markets including industrial, commercial, institutional and agricultural. Our service versatility allows us to support the varying needs of our diverse customer base, which includes general contractors and sub-contractors, developers, manufacturers, distributors and a current network of over 3,300 authorized builders across North America.

We are comprised of a family of companies operating 31 manufacturing facilities spanning the United States and Mexico, with additional sales and distribution offices throughout the United States and Canada. Our broad geographic footprint along with our hub-and-spoke distribution system allows us to efficiently supply a broad range of customers with high quality customer service and reliable deliveries.

The Company was founded in 1984 and reincorporated in Delaware in 1991. In 1998, we acquired Metal Building Components, Inc. (“MBCI”) and doubled our revenue base. As a result of the acquisition of MBCI, we became the largest domestic manufacturer of nonresidential metal components. In 2006, we acquired Robertson-Ceco II Corporation (“RCC”) which operates the Ceco Building Systems, Star Building Systems and Robertson Building Systems divisions and is a leader in the metal buildings industry. The RCC acquisition created an organization with greater product and geographic diversification, a stronger customer base and a more extensive distribution network than either company had individually, prior to the acquisition.

The metal coil coating, metal components and engineered building systems businesses, and the construction industry in general, are seasonal in nature. Sales normally are lower in the first half of each fiscal year compared to the second half of the fiscal year because of unfavorable weather conditions for construction and typical business planning cycles affecting construction.

The nonresidential construction industry is highly sensitive to national and regional macroeconomic conditions. One of the primary challenges we face in the short term is that the United States economy is slowly recovering from a recession and is in a period of significant volatility which, beginning in the third quarter of 2008, has reduced demand for our products and adversely affected our business. In addition, the tightening of credit in financial markets over the same period has adversely affected the ability of our customers to obtain financing for construction projects. As a result, we have experienced decreases in and cancellations of orders for our products in previous fiscal quarters, and the ability of our customers to make payments has been adversely affected. Similar factors could cause our suppliers to experience financial distress or bankruptcy, resulting in temporary raw material shortages. The lack of credit also adversely affects nonresidential construction, which is the focus of our business. While economic growth has either resumed or remains flat, the nonresidential construction industry continues to face significant challenges.

When assessing the state of the metal construction market, we review information from various industry associations, third-party research, and various government reports such as industrial production and capacity

 

5


Table of Contents

utilization. One such industry association is the Metal Building Manufacturers Association (“MBMA”), which provides summary member sales information and promotes the design and construction of metal buildings and metal roofing systems. Another is McGraw-Hill Construction Information Group, which we review for information regarding actual and forecasted growth in various construction related industries, including the overall nonresidential construction market. McGraw-Hill Construction’s nonresidential construction forecast for calendar 2011, updated in October 2011, indicates an expected reduction of 4% in square footage and a decrease of 6% in dollar value as compared to the prior calendar year. In calendar 2012, activity is expected to increase compared to calendar 2011, with an expected increase of 2% in square footage and an increase of 2% in dollar value. Additionally, we review the American Institute of Architects’ (“AIA”) survey for inquiry and billing activity for the industrial, commercial and institutional sectors. The AIA’s Architectural Billing Index (“ABI”) is a closely watched metric, as billing growth for architectural services generally leads to construction spending growth for the following 9 to 12 months. An ABI reading above 50 indicates an increase in month-to-month billings and a reading below 50 indicates a decrease in month-to-month billings. AIA’s ABI published for October 2011 was below 50 at 49.4 but the commercial and industrial component of the index was at 53.5 for October 2011, the second consecutive month above 50.

As a result of the market downturn in 2008 and 2009, we implemented a three-phase process to resize and realign our manufacturing operations. The purpose of these activities was to close some of our least efficient facilities and to retool certain facilities to allow us to better utilize our assets and expand into new markets or better provide products to our customers, such as insulated panel systems. After the implementation of this three-phase restructuring plan, we are realizing significant fixed cost savings compared to fiscal year 2008. We have incurred facility closure costs of $20.3 million through October 31, 2010 related to the three-phase restructuring plan and have not incurred significant additional costs beyond fiscal 2010 under the plan.

Another challenge we face both short and long term is the volatility in the price of steel. Our business is heavily dependent on the supply of steel and is significantly impacted by steel prices. For the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011, steel represented approximately 72% of our costs of goods sold. The steel industry is highly cyclical in nature, and steel prices have been volatile in recent years and may remain volatile in the future. Steel prices are influenced by numerous factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions domestically and internationally, currency fluctuations, availability of raw materials, competition, labor costs, freight and transportation costs, production costs, import duties and other trade restrictions.

The monthly CRU North American Steel Price Index, published by the CRU Group, has increased 16.8% from October 2010 to October 2011 and was 2.6% higher in October 2010 compared to October 2009. Generally, we are able to adjust our sales prices in response to fluctuations in steel costs. However, in 2009, the combination of a precipitous decline in steel costs and rapid deceleration in construction activity negatively impacted our results of operations. In the first two quarters of fiscal 2009, we recorded a $40.0 million charge to cost of sales to adjust certain raw material inventory to the lower of cost or market because this inventory exceeded our estimates of net realizable value less normal profit margins. Our sales volume in 2009 was significantly lower than previously anticipated as customers delayed projects in an effort to wait and see how low steel prices would fall.

On October 20, 2009, we completed a financial restructuring that resulted in a change of control of the Company. As part of the restructuring, Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. and CD&R Friends & Family Fund VIII, L.P. (together, the “CD&R Funds”), investment funds managed by Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, LLC, purchased an aggregate of 250,000 shares of a newly created class of our convertible preferred stock, par value $1.00 per share, designated the Series B Cumulative Convertible Participating Preferred Stock (the “Convertible Preferred Stock,” and shares thereof, the “Preferred Shares”), representing approximately 68.4% of the voting power and common stock of the Company on an as-converted basis (the “Equity Investment”). In connection with the closing of the Equity Investment, among other things:

 

   

we consummated an exchange offer (the “Exchange Offer”) to acquire all of our existing $180 million aggregate principal amount 2.125% Convertible Senior Subordinated Notes due 2024 in exchange for a combination of $90.0 million in cash and 14.0 million shares of common stock;

 

6


Table of Contents
   

we refinanced our existing term loan by repaying approximately $143 million in principal amount of the then existing $293 million in principal amount of outstanding term loans and amending the terms and extending the maturity of the remaining $150 million balance (the “Amended Credit Agreement”); and

 

   

we entered into an asset-based revolving credit facility with a maximum available amount of up to $125 million (the “ABL Facility”). See “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources.”

As of November 1, 2009, the Preferred Shares were convertible into 39.2 million shares of Common Stock, respectively, at an initial conversion price of $6.3740 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split, described below). However, as of November 1, 2009, only approximately 1.8 million shares of Common Stock were authorized and unissued, and therefore the CD&R Funds would not have been able to fully convert the Preferred Shares. To the extent the CD&R Funds opted to convert their Preferred Shares, as of November 1, 2009, their conversion right was limited to conversion of that portion of their Preferred Shares into the approximately 1.8 million shares of Common Stock that were currently authorized and unissued. On March 5, 2010, following shareholder approval and by action of the independent, non-CD&R board members, we were able to effect the Reverse Stock Split at an exchange ratio of 1-for-5. As of that date, the Preferred Shares accrued for and held by the CD&R Funds were fully convertible into 41.0 million Common Shares.

Dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock are payable, on a cumulative daily basis, as and if declared by our board of directors, at a rate per annum of 12% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus accrued and unpaid dividends thereon or at a rate per annum of 8% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon if paid in cash on the dividend payment date on which such dividends would otherwise compound. Members of our board of directors who are not affiliated with the CD&R Funds, have the right to choose whether such dividends are paid in cash or in-kind, subject to the conditions of the Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility.

On December 3, 2010, we finalized an amendment of our ABL facility which, among other items, relaxed the prohibitions against paying cash dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stocks to allow, in the aggregate, up to $6.5 million of cash dividends or other payments each calendar quarter, provided (i) certain excess availability conditions or (ii) excess availability conditions and a fixed charge coverage ratio under the ABL Facility are satisfied. In addition, our Amended Credit Agreement currently restricts the payment of cash dividends to 50% of cumulative earnings beginning with the fourth quarter of 2009, and in the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan.

On September 6, 2011, we entered into a Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock, agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended September 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares, and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the remainder of its fiscal year ending October 30, 2011, subject to certain exceptions.

The September 6, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after September 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 30, 2011.

On December 9, 2011, we entered into a second Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock,

 

7


Table of Contents

agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended December 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares, and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the fiscal year ending October 28, 2012, subject to certain exceptions.

The December 9, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after December 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 28, 2012.

Our principal offices are located at 10943 North Sam Houston Parkway West, Houston, Texas 77064, and our telephone number is (281) 897-7788.

We file annual, quarterly and current reports and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). Our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K, along with any amendments to those reports, are available free of charge at our corporate website at http://www.ncilp.com as soon as practicable after such material is electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. In addition, our website includes other items related to corporate governance matters, including our corporate governance guidelines, charters of various committees of our board of directors and the code of business conduct and ethics applicable to our employees, officers and directors. You may obtain copies of these documents, free of charge, from our corporate website. However, the information on our website is not incorporated by reference into this Form 10-K.

Business Segments

We have aggregated our operations into three reportable business segments based upon similarities in product lines, manufacturing processes, marketing and management of our businesses: (i) metal coil coating; (ii) metal components; and (iii) engineered building systems. Our business segments are vertically integrated, benefiting from common raw material usage, like manufacturing processes and an overlapping distribution network. Steel is the primary raw material used by each of our business segments. Our metal coil coating segment, which paints steel coils, provides substantially all of our metal coil coating requirements for our metal components and engineered building systems business segments. Our metal components segment produces parts and accessories that are sold separately or as part of a comprehensive solution, the most common of which is a metal building system custom-designed and manufactured in our engineered building systems segment. Our engineered building systems segment sources substantially all of its painted steel coil and a large portion of its components requirements from our other two business segments. The manufacturing and distribution activities of our segments are effectively coupled through the use of our nationwide hub-and-spoke manufacturing and distribution system, which supports and enhances our vertical integration.

Corporate assets consist primarily of cash but also include deferred financing costs, deferred taxes and property, plant and equipment associated with our headquarters in Houston, Texas. These items (and income and expenses related to these items) are not allocated to the business segments. Corporate unallocated expenses include executive, legal, finance, tax, treasury, human resources, information technology, purchasing, marketing and corporate travel expenses. Additional unallocated expenses include interest income, interest expense, debt extinguishment and refinancing costs and other (expense) income.

 

8


Table of Contents

Our total sales, external sales, operating income (loss) and total assets attributable to these business segments were as follows for the fiscal years indicated (in thousands):

 

     2011     %     2010     %     2009     %  

Total sales:

            

Metal coil coating

   $ 201,098        21      $ 181,874        21      $ 169,897        18   

Metal components

     437,655        46        415,857        48        458,734        47   

Engineered building systems

     548,594        57        490,746        56        538,938        56   

Intersegment sales

     (227,770     (24     (217,951     (25     (202,317     (21
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net sales

   $ 959,577        100      $ 870,526        100      $ 965,252        100   

External sales:

            

Metal coil coating

   $ 75,394        8      $ 65,240        7      $ 53,189        6   

Metal components

     353,797        37        328,077        38        389,132        40   

Engineered building systems

     530,386        55        477,209        55        522,931        54   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net sales

   $ 959,577        100      $ 870,526        100      $ 965,252        100   

Operating income (loss):

            

Metal coil coating

   $ 17,944        $ 16,166        $ (99,689  

Metal components

     20,643          26,791          (130,039  

Engineered building systems

     13,011          (18,438       (389,007  

Corporate

     (53,225       (49,106       (64,583  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total operating income (loss)

   $ (1,627     $ (24,587     $ (683,318  

Unallocated other expense

     (14,720       (15,620       (124,391  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Loss before income taxes

   $ (16,347     $ (40,207     $ (807,709  

Total assets as of fiscal year end 2011 and 2010:

            

Metal coil coating

   $ 55,509        10      $ 57,137        10      $ 57,254        9   

Metal components

     175,906        31        167,542        30        160,124        26   

Engineered building systems

     206,232        37        208,232        37        241,046        39   

Corporate

     123,507        22        127,613        23        155,744        26   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 561,154        100      $ 560,524        100      $ 614,168        100   

Metal Coil Coating.

Products. Metal coil coating consists of cleaning, treating and painting various flat-rolled metals, in coil form, as well as slitting and/or embossing the metal, before the metal is fabricated for use by various industrial users. Light gauge and heavy gauge metal coils that are painted, either for decorative or corrosion protection purposes, are utilized in the building industry by manufacturers of metal components and engineered building systems. In addition, these painted metal coils are utilized by manufacturers of other products, such as water heaters, lighting fixtures, ceiling grids, HVAC and appliances. We clean, treat and coat both heavy gauge (hot-rolled) and light gauge metal coils for our other business segments and for third party customers, who utilize them in a variety of applications, including construction products, heating and air conditioning systems, water heaters, lighting fixtures, ceiling grids, office furniture, appliances and other products. We provide toll coating processes under which the customer provides the metal coil and we provide only the coil coating process. We also provide a painted metal package under which we sell both the metal coil and the coil coating service together.

We believe that pre-painted metal coils provide manufacturers with a higher quality, environmentally cleaner and more cost-effective solution to operating their own in-house painting operations. Pre-painted metal coils also offer manufacturers the opportunity to produce a broader and more aesthetically pleasing range of products.

Manufacturing. We currently operate five metal coil coating facilities located in five U.S. states. Two of our facilities coat hot-rolled, heavy gauge metal coils and three of our facilities coat light gauge metal coils. In 2010,

 

9


Table of Contents

we acquired an idle coil coating facility located in Middletown, Ohio. The idle facility includes a 170,000 square foot coil coating plant situated on approximately 21 acres of land. Depending on market conditions, we anticipate the Middletown, Ohio facility will remain idle until fiscal 2013, at the earliest. Additional capital expenditures are necessary for the facility to meet our purposes and required efficiencies.

Our coil coating processes have multiple stages. In the first stage, the metal surface is cleaned and a chemical pretreatment is applied. The pretreatment is designed to promote adhesion of the paint system and enhance the corrosion resistance of the metal. After the pretreatment stage, a paint system is roll-applied to the metal surface, then baked at a high temperature to cure the coating and achieve a set of physical properties that not only make the metal more attractive, but also allows it to be formed into a manufactured product, all while maintaining the integrity of the paint system so that it can endure the final end use requirements. After the coating system has been cured, the metal substrate is rewound into a finished metal coil and packaged for shipment. Slitting and embossing processes can also be performed on the finished coil in accordance with customer specifications, prior to shipment.

Sales, Marketing and Customers. We process metal coils to supply substantially all the coating requirements of our own metal components and engineered building systems business segments. We also process metal coils to supply external customers in a number of different industries.

We market our metal coil coating products and processes under the brand names “Metal Coaters” and “Metal Prep”. Each of our metal coil coating facilities has an independent sales staff.

We sell our products and processes principally to OEM customers who utilize pre-painted metal, including other manufacturers of engineered building systems and metal components. Our customer base also includes steel mills, metal service centers and painted coil distributors who in-turn supply various manufacturers of engineered building systems, metal components, lighting fixtures, ceiling grids, water heaters, appliances and other manufactured products. This is in addition to supplying our own metal components and engineered building systems business segments. During fiscal 2011, the largest customer of our metal coil coating segment accounted for approximately 1.9% of our total consolidated sales.

According to information collected by the National Coil Coating Association and from other market sources, we estimate that approximately 0.35 to 0.45 million tons of heavy gauge, metal substrate and approximately 2.9 to 3.1 million (normalized) tons of light gauge, flat rolled metal substrate are currently being coated on an annual basis in the United States. We estimate that we account for approximately 40% of the current heavy gauge, coated steel market and approximately 12% of the current light gauge, coated steel market.

Metal Components.

Products. Metal components include metal roof and wall systems, metal partitions, metal trim, doors and other related accessories. These products are used in new construction and in repair and retrofit applications for industrial, commercial, institutional, agricultural and rural uses. Metal components are used in a wide variety of construction applications, including purlins and girts, roofing, standing seam roofing, walls, doors, trim and other parts of traditional buildings, as well as in architectural applications and engineered building systems. Purlins and girts are medium gauge, roll-formed steel components, which builders use for secondary structural framing. Although precise market data is limited, we estimate the metal components market including roofing applications to be a multi-billion dollar market. We believe that metal products have gained and continue to gain a greater share of new construction and repair and retrofit markets due to increasing acceptance and recognition of the benefits of metal products in building applications.

Our metal components consist of individual components, including secondary structural framing, metal roof and wall systems and associated metal trims. We sell directly to contractors or end users for use in the building industry, including the construction of metal buildings. We also stock and market metal component parts for use

 

10


Table of Contents

in the maintenance and repair of existing buildings. Specific component products we manufacture include metal roof and wall systems, purlins, girts, partitions, header panels and related trim and screws. We are also developing and marketing new products such as our Insulated Panel Systems (“IPS”), Eco-ficienttm panel systems, SoundwallTM, Nu-RoofTM system and Energy Star cool roofing. We believe we offer the widest selection of metal components in the building industry. We custom produce purlins and girts for our customers and offer one of the widest selections of sizes and profiles in the United States. Metal roof and wall systems protect the rest of the structure and the contents of the building from the weather. They may also contribute to the structural integrity of the building.

Metal roofing systems have several advantages over conventional roofing systems, including the following:

Lower life cycle cost. The total cost over the life of metal roofing systems is lower than that of conventional roofing systems for both new construction and retrofit roofing. For new construction, the cost of installing metal roofing is greater than the cost of conventional roofing. Yet, the longer life and lower maintenance costs of metal roofing make the cost more attractive. For retrofit roofing, although installation costs are higher for metal roofing due to the need for a sloping support system, the lower ongoing costs more than offset the initial cost.

Increased longevity. Metal roofing systems generally last for a minimum of 20 years without requiring major maintenance or replacement. This compares to five to ten years for conventional roofs. The cost of leaks and roof failures associated with conventional roofing can be very high, including damage to building interiors and disruption of the functional usefulness of the building. Metal roofing prolongs the intervals between costly and time-consuming repair work.

Attractive aesthetics and design flexibility. Metal roofing systems allow architects and builders to integrate colors and geometric design into the roofing of new and existing buildings, providing an increasingly fashionable means of enhancing a building’s aesthetics. Conventional roofing material is generally tar paper or a gravel surface, and building designers tend to conceal roofs made with these materials.

Our metal roofing products are attractive and durable. We use standing seam roof technology to replace traditional built-up and single-ply roofs as well as to provide a distinctive look to new construction.

Manufacturing. We currently operate 18 facilities in 10 states used for manufacturing of metal components for the nonresidential construction industry, including three facilities for our door operations and one facility for our insulated panel systems.

Metal component products are roll-formed or fabricated at each plant using roll-formers and other metal working equipment. In roll-forming, pre-finished coils of steel are unwound and passed through a series of progressive forming rolls that form the steel into various profiles of medium-gauge structural shapes and light-gauge roof and wall panels.

Sales, Marketing and Customers. We are one of the largest domestic suppliers of metal components to the nonresidential building industry. We design, manufacture, sell and distribute one of the widest selections of components for a variety of new construction applications as well as for repair and retrofit uses.

We manufacture and design metal roofing systems for sales to regional metal building manufacturers, general contractors and subcontractors. We believe we have the broadest line of standing seam roofing products in the building industry. In addition, we have granted 21 non-exclusive, on-going license agreements to 18 companies, both domestic and international, relating to our standing seam roof technology.

These licenses, for a fee, are provided with MBCI’s technical know-how relating to the marketing, sales, testing, engineering, estimating, manufacture and installation of the licensed product. The licensees buy their own roll forming equipment to manufacture the roof panels and typically buy accessories for the licensed roof system from MBCI.

 

11


Table of Contents

We estimate that metal roofing currently accounts for less than 10% of total roofing material volume. However, metal roofing accounts for a significant portion of the overall metal components market. As a result, we believe that significant opportunities exist for metal roofing, with its advantages over conventional roofing materials, to increase its overall share of this market.

In addition to metal roofing systems, we manufacture roll-up doors and sell interior and exterior walk doors for use in the self-storage industry and metal and other buildings. In addition, one of our strategic objectives and a major part of our “green” initiative is to expand our insulated panel product lines which are increasingly desirable because of their energy efficiency, noise reduction and aesthetic qualities. We retooled one facility in Jackson, Mississippi to manufacture insulated panels and this facility is now operational. Two additional idled facilities are being retooled to produce insulated metal panels and are expected to become operational in 2012.

Our “green” initiative enables us to capitalize on increasing consumer preferences for environmentally-friendly construction. We believe this will allow us to further service the needs of our existing customer base and to gain new customers. For more information about our “green” initiatives, please see “— Business Strategy.”

We sell metal components directly to regional manufacturers, contractors, subcontractors, distributors, lumberyards, cooperative buying groups and other customers under the brand names “MBCI,” “American Building Components” (“ABC”), “IPS” and “Metal Depots.” Roll-up doors, interior and exterior doors, interior partitions and walls, header panels and trim are sold directly to contractors and other customers under the brand “Doors and Buildings Components” (“DBCI”). These components also are produced for integration into self-storage and engineered building systems sold by us. In addition to a traditional business-to-business channel, we sell components through Metal Depots which has six retail stores in Texas and New Mexico and specifically targets end-use consumers and small general contractors.

We market our components products within five product lines: commercial/industrial, architectural, standing seam roof systems, agricultural and residential. Customers include small, medium and large contractors, specialty roofers, regional fabricators, regional engineered building fabricators, post frame contractors, material resellers and end users. Commercial and industrial businesses, including self-storage, are heavy users of metal components and metal buildings systems. Standing seam roof and architectural customers have emerged as an important part of our customer base. As metal buildings become a more acceptable building alternative and aesthetics become an increasingly important consideration for end users of metal buildings, we believe that architects will participate more in the design and purchase decisions and will use metal components to a greater extent. Wood frame builders also purchase our metal components through distributors, lumberyards, cooperative buying groups and chain stores for various uses, including agricultural buildings.

Our metal components sales operations are organized into geographic regions. Each region is headed by a general sales manager supported by individual plant sales managers. Each local sales office is located adjacent to a manufacturing plant and is staffed by a direct sales force responsible for contacting customers and architects and a sales coordinator who supervises the sales process from the time the order is received until it is shipped and invoiced. The regional and local focus of our customers requires extensive knowledge of local business conditions. During fiscal 2011, our largest customer for metal components accounted for less than 1% of our total consolidated sales.

Engineered Building Systems.

Products. Engineered building systems consist of engineered structural members and panels that are fabricated and roll-formed in a factory. These systems are custom designed and engineered to meet project requirements and then shipped to a construction site complete and ready for assembly with no additional field welding required. Engineered building systems manufacturers design an integrated system that meets applicable building code and designated end use requirements. These systems consist of primary structural framing, secondary structural members (purlins and girts) and metal roof and wall systems or conventional wall materials manufactured by others, such as masonry and concrete tilt-up panels.

 

12


Table of Contents

Engineered building systems typically consist of three systems:

Primary structural framing. Primary structural framing, fabricated from heavy-gauge plate steel, supports the secondary structural framing, roof, walls and all externally applied loads. Through the primary framing, the force of all applied loads is structurally transferred to the foundation.

Secondary structural framing. Secondary structural framing is designed to strengthen the primary structural framing and efficiently transfer applied loads from the roof and walls to the primary structural framing. Secondary structural framing consists of medium-gauge, roll-formed steel components called purlins and girts. Purlins are attached to the primary frame to support the roof. Girts are attached to the primary frame to support the walls.

Metal roof and wall systems. Metal roof and wall systems not only lock out the weather but may also contribute to the structural integrity of the overall building system. Roof and wall panels are fabricated from light-gauge, roll-formed steel in many architectural configurations.

Accessory components complete the engineered building system. These components include doors, windows, specialty trims, gutters and interior partitions.

The following characteristics of engineered building systems distinguish them from other methods of construction:

Shorter construction time. In many instances, it takes less time to construct an engineered building than other building types. In addition, because most of the work is done in the factory, the likelihood of weather interruptions is reduced.

More efficient material utilization. The larger engineered building systems manufacturers use computer-aided analysis and design to fabricate structural members with high strength-to-weight ratios, minimizing raw materials costs.

Lower construction costs. The in-plant manufacture of engineered building systems, coupled with automation, allows the substitution of less expensive factory labor for much of the skilled on-site construction labor otherwise required for traditional building methods.

Greater ease of expansion. Engineered building systems can be modified quickly and economically before, during or after the building is completed to accommodate all types of expansion. Typically, an engineered building system can be expanded by removing the end or side walls, erecting new framework and adding matching wall and roof panels.

Lower maintenance costs. Unlike wood, metal is not susceptible to deterioration from cracking, rotting or insect damage. Furthermore, factory-applied roof and siding panel coatings resist cracking, peeling, chipping, chalking and fading.

Environmentally friendly. Our buildings utilize between 30% and 60% recycled content and our roofing and siding utilize painted surfaces with high reflectance and emissivity, which help conserve energy and operating costs.

Manufacturing. We currently operate 8 facilities for manufacturing and distributing engineered building systems throughout the United States and Monterrey, Mexico.

After we receive an order, our engineers design the engineered building system to meet the customer’s requirements and to satisfy applicable building codes and zoning requirements. To expedite this process, we use computer-aided design and engineering systems to generate engineering and erection drawings and a bill of materials for the manufacture of the engineered building system. From time-to-time, depending on our volume, we outsource to third-parties portions of our drafting requirements.

 

13


Table of Contents

Once the specifications and designs of the customer’s project have been finalized, the manufacturing of frames and other building systems begins at one of our frame manufacturing facilities. Fabrication of the primary structural framing consists of a process in which steel plates are punched and sheared and then routed through an automatic welding machine and sent through further fitting and welding processes. The secondary structural framing and the covering system are roll-formed steel products that are manufactured at our full manufacturing facilities as well as our components plants.

Upon completion of the manufacturing process, structural framing members and metal roof and wall systems are shipped to the job site for assembly. Since on-site construction is performed by an unaffiliated, independent general contractor, usually one of our authorized builders, we generally are not responsible for claims by end users or owners attributable to faulty on-site construction. The time elapsed between our receipt of an order and shipment of a completed building system has typically ranged from six to twelve weeks, although delivery varies depending on engineering and drafting requirements and the length of the permitting process.

Sales, Marketing and Customers. We are one of the largest domestic suppliers of engineered building systems. We design, engineer, manufacture and market engineered building systems and self-storage building systems for all nonresidential markets including commercial, industrial, agricultural, governmental and community.

Throughout the twentieth century, the applications of metal buildings have significantly evolved from small, portable structures that prospered during World War II into fully customizable building solutions spanning virtually every commercial low-rise end-use market. According to the MBMA, domestic and export sales of engineered building systems by its members, which represent a portion of the number of actual buildings manufactured totaled approximately $1.7 billion for each of 2010 and 2009, while tons shipped increased 11% over the same period. Although final 2011 sales information is not yet available from the MBMA, we estimate that sales of engineered building systems will increase in 2011 compared with 2010 while tons shipped will be relatively flat over the same period. McGraw-Hill Construction reported that the low-rise nonresidential market, measured in square footage, actually declined by 5.9% during our fiscal year 2011. McGraw-Hill Construction’s forecast for calendar 2011 indicates a total nonresidential construction reduction of 4% in square footage and 6% in dollar value. The forecast for calendar 2012 indicates a total nonresidential construction expected increase of 2% in square footage and 2% in dollar value over 2011.

We believe the cost of an engineered building system, excluding the cost of the land, generally represents approximately 10% to 15% of the total cost of constructing a building, which includes such elements as labor, plumbing, electricity, heating and air conditioning systems, installation and interior finish. Technological advances in products and materials, as well as significant improvements in engineering and design techniques, have led to the development of structural systems that are compatible with more traditional construction materials. Architects and designers now often combine an engineered building system with masonry, concrete, glass and wood exterior facades to meet the aesthetic requirements of end users while preserving the inherent characteristics of engineered building systems. As a result, the uses for engineered building systems now include office buildings, showrooms, retail shopping centers, banks, schools, places of worship, warehouses, factories, distribution centers, government buildings and community centers for which aesthetics and architectural features are important considerations of the end users. In addition, advances in our products such as insulated steel panel systems for roof and wall applications give buildings the desired balance of strength, thermal efficiency and attractiveness.

We sell engineered building systems to builders, general contractors, developers and end users nationwide under the brand names “Metallic,” “Mid-West Steel,” “A & S,” “All American,” “Steel Systems,” “Mesco,” “Star,” “Ceco,” “Robertson,” “Garco,” “Heritage” and “SteelBuilding.com.” We market engineered building systems through an in-house sales force to authorized builder networks of over 3,400 builders. We also sell engineered building systems via direct sale to owners and end users as well as through private label companies.

 

14


Table of Contents

In addition to a traditional business-to-business channel, we sell small custom-engineered metal buildings through two other consumer-oriented marketing channels targeting end-use purchasers and small general contractors. We sell through Heritage Building Systems (“Heritage”) which is a direct-response, phone-based sales organization and Steelbuilding.com which allows customers to design, price and buy small metal buildings online. During fiscal 2011, our largest customer for engineered building systems accounted for less than 1% of our total consolidated sales.

The majority of our sales of engineered building systems are made through our authorized builder networks. We enter into an authorized builder agreement with independent general contractors that market our products and services to users. These agreements generally grant the builder the non-exclusive right to market our products in a specified territory. Generally, the agreement is cancelable by either party on 60 days’ notice. The agreement does not prohibit the builder from marketing engineered building systems of other manufacturers. We establish an annual sales goal for each builder and provide the builder with sales and pricing information, drawings and assistance, application programs for estimating and quoting jobs and advertising and promotional literature. In some cases, we also defray a portion of the builder’s advertising costs and provide volume purchasing and other pricing incentives to encourage those businesses to deal exclusively or principally with us. The builder is required to maintain a place of business in its designated territory, provide a sales organization, conduct periodic advertising programs and perform construction, warranty and other services for customers and potential customers. An authorized builder usually is hired by an end-user to erect an engineered building system on the customer’s site and provide general contracting and other services related to the completion of the project. We sell our products to the builder, which generally includes the price of the building as a part of its overall construction contract with its customer. We rely upon maintaining a satisfactory business relationship for continuing job orders from our authorized builders.

Business Strategy

We intend to expand our business, enhance our market position and increase our sales and profitability by focusing on the implementation of a number of key initiatives that we believe will help us grow and reduce costs. Our current strategy focuses primarily on organic initiatives, but also considers the use of opportunistic acquisitions to achieve our growth objectives:

 

   

Corporate-Wide Initiatives

Fixed cost containment as the nonresidential construction market improves is our top corporate-wide initiative. We will continue our focus on leveraging technology and automation to be one of the lowest cost producers, and enhance plant utilization through expanded use of our hub & spoke distribution model.

 

   

Metal Coil Coating Segment

Through diversification of our external customer base, we plan to substantially increase toll and package sales and make the segment somewhat less dependent on the construction industry. We plan to bring our recently purchased Middletown, OH coating facility on-line by the end of 2012 and we will continue to leverage efficiency improvements to be one of the lowest cost producers.

 

   

Components Segment

We intend to maintain our leading positions in these markets and seek opportunities to profitably expand our customer base. We plan to expand our insulated panel capabilities and product offering utilizing our retooled state-of-the-art manufacturing facility in Jackson, MS and two additional retooled locations scheduled to be operational in 2012. In addition, we plan to accelerate and expand Nu-Rooftm, our retrofit roofing product.

 

   

Buildings Segment

We intend to maintain our leading positions in these markets and seek opportunities to profitably expand our customer base. We will continue to enhance and share engineering and drafting technologies

 

15


Table of Contents

across all Buildings brands, while at the same time continuing to increase product standardization. We intend to expand material sales by offering furnish & erect services and the ability to supply higher complexity structures for the Industrial market. In addition, we have deployed and are enhancing web-based pricing software to enhance small building sales across our brands and provide rapid delivery guarantees.

Raw Materials

The principal raw material used in manufacturing of our metal components and engineered building systems is steel. Our various products are fabricated from steel produced by mills including bars, plates, structural shapes, sheets, hot-rolled coils and galvanized or Galvalume®-coated coils. We purchased approximately 33% of our steel requirements from two vendors in fiscal 2011 and 36% of our steel requirements from two vendors in fiscal 2010. No other vendor accounted for over 10% of our steel requirements during fiscal 2011 or 2010. Although we believe concentration of our steel purchases among a small group of suppliers that have mills and warehouse facilities close to our facilities enables us, as a large customer of those suppliers, to obtain better pricing, service and delivery, the loss of one or all of these suppliers could have a material adverse effect on our ability to obtain the raw materials required to meet delivery schedules to our customers. These suppliers generally maintain an inventory of the types of materials we require.

Our raw materials on hand increased to $64.2 million at October 30, 2011 from $56.8 million at October 31, 2010 due to increased steel costs, partially offset by a decrease in tons on-hand. During fiscal 2009, we recorded a charge of $40.0 million to reduce the carrying amount on certain raw material inventory to the lower of cost or market due to the rapid deceleration in construction activity combined with precipitous declines in steel costs. No such charge was required during fiscal 2011 or 2010.

Our business is heavily dependent on the price and supply of steel. The steel industry is highly cyclical in nature, and steel prices have been volatile in recent years and may remain volatile in the future. Steel prices are influenced by numerous factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions domestically and internationally, currency fluctuations, the availability of raw materials, competition, labor costs, freight and transportation costs, production costs, import duties and other trade restrictions. We believe the CRU North American Steel Price Index, published by the CRU Group since 1994, appropriately depicts the volatility in steel prices. See “Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk — Steel Prices.” During fiscal 2011 and 2010, steel prices fluctuated significantly due to market conditions ranging from a high point on the CRU Index of 219 to a low point of 146 in fiscal 2011 and fluctuated significantly from a high point on the CRU Index of 182 to a low point of 140 in fiscal 2010. Given the level of steel industry consolidation, the anticipated additional domestic market capacity from new entrants, generally low inventories in the industry and slow economic recovery, we believe steel prices will continue to be volatile and will be slightly higher, on average, in fiscal 2012 as compared with the prices we experienced during fiscal 2011.

Although we have the ability to purchase steel from a number of suppliers, a production cutback by one or more of our current suppliers could create challenges to meet delivery schedules to our customers. Because we have periodically adjusted our contract prices, particularly in the engineered building systems segment, we have generally been able to pass increases in our raw material costs through to our customers. We do not have any long-term contracts for the purchase of steel and normally do not maintain an inventory of steel in excess of our current production requirements. However, from time to time, we may purchase steel in advance of announced steel price increases. In addition, it is our current practice to purchase all steel consignment inventory that remains in consignment after an agreed term. Therefore, our inventory may increase if demand for our products declines. For additional information about the risks of our raw material supply and pricing, see “Item 1A. Risk Factors.”

Backlog

At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the total backlog of orders, primarily consisting of engineered building systems’ orders, for our products we believe to be firm was $216.4 million and $193.9 million,

 

16


Table of Contents

respectively. Job orders included in backlog are generally cancelable by customers at any time for any reason. Economic conditions resulted in higher levels of cancellations in fiscal 2009 and 2010 than we historically have experienced. See “Item 1A. Risk Factors — Our industry is cyclical and highly sensitive to macroeconomic conditions; as a result, our industry is currently experiencing a downturn which, if sustained, will materially and adversely affect our business, liquidity and results of operations.” Occasionally, orders in the backlog are not completed and shipped for reasons that include changes in the requirements of the customers and the inability of customers to obtain necessary financing or zoning variances. We anticipate that less than 10% of this backlog will extend beyond one year.

Competition

We and other manufacturers of metal components and engineered building systems compete in the building industry with all other alternative methods of building construction such as tilt-wall, concrete and wood, single-ply and built up, all of which may be perceived as more traditional, more aesthetically pleasing or having other advantages over our products. We compete with all manufacturers of building products, from small local firms to large national firms.

In addition, competition in the metal components and engineered building systems market of the building industry is intense. It is based primarily on:

 

   

quality;

 

   

service;

 

   

on-time delivery;

 

   

ability to provide added value in the design and engineering of buildings;

 

   

price;

 

   

speed of construction; and

 

   

personal relationships with customers.

We compete with a number of other manufacturers of metal components and engineered building systems for the building industry, ranging from small local firms to large national firms. Most of these competitors operate on a regional basis, although we believe that at least two other manufacturers of engineered building systems and three manufacturers of metal components have nationwide coverage.

We are comprised of a family of companies operating 31 manufacturing facilities across the United States and Mexico, with additional sales and distribution offices throughout the United States and Canada. These facilities are used for the manufacturing of metal components and engineered building systems for the building industry, including three for our door operations. We believe this broad geographic distribution gives us an advantage over our components and building competitors because major elements of a customer’s decision are the speed and cost of delivery from the manufacturing facility to the product’s ultimate destination. We operate a fleet of trucks to deliver our products to our customers in a more timely manner than most of our competitors.

We compete with a number of other providers of metal coil coating services to manufacturers of metal components and engineered building systems for the building industry, ranging from small local firms to large national firms. Most of these competitors operate on a regional basis, although we believe there are at least three other providers of light gauge metal coil coating services that have a nationwide market presence. Also, there are two other providers of heavy gauge metal coil coating services who have substantially the same geographic reach as our heavy gauge coil coating facilities. Competition in the metal coil coating industry is intense and is based primarily on quality, service, delivery and price.

 

17


Table of Contents

Consolidation

Over the last several years, there has been a consolidation of competitors within the industries of the metal coil coating, metal components and engineered building systems segments, which include many small local and regional firms. We believe that these industries will continue to consolidate, driven by the needs of manufacturers to increase anticipated long-term manufacturing capacity, achieve greater process integration and add geographic diversity to meet customers’ product and delivery needs, improve production efficiency and manage costs. When beneficial to our long-term goals and strategy, we have sought to consolidate our business operations with other companies. The resulting synergies from these consolidation efforts have allowed us to reduce costs while continuing to serve our customers’ needs. In January 2007, we completed the purchase of substantially all of the assets of Garco Building Systems, Inc. which designs, manufactures and distributes steel building systems primarily for markets in the northwestern United States and western Canada. In April 2006, we acquired 100% of the issued and outstanding shares of RCC. RCC operates the Ceco Building Systems, Star Building Systems and Robertson Building Systems divisions and is a leader in the metal buildings segment. For more information, see “— Acquisitions.”

In addition to the consolidation of competitors within the industries of the metal coil coating, metal components and engineered building systems segments, in recent years there has been consolidation between those industries and steel producers. Several of our competitors have been acquired by steel producers, and further similar acquisitions are possible. For a discussion of the possible effects on us of such consolidations, see “Item 1A. Risk Factors.”

Acquisitions

We have a history of making acquisitions within our industry, and we regularly evaluate growth opportunities both through acquisitions and internal investment. We believe that there remain opportunities for growth through consolidation in the metal buildings and components segments, and our goal is to continue to grow through opportunistic strategic acquisitions, as well as organically.

Consistent with our growth strategy, we frequently engage in discussions with potential sellers regarding the possible purchase by us of businesses, assets and operations that are strategic and complementary to our existing operations. Such assets and operations include engineered building systems and metal components, but may also include assets that are closely related to, or intertwined with, these business lines, and enable us to leverage our asset base, knowledge base and skill sets. Such acquisition efforts may involve participation by us in processes that have been made public, involve a number of potential buyers and are commonly referred to as “auction” processes, as well as situations in which we believe we are the only party or one of the very limited number of potential buyers in negotiations with the potential seller. These acquisition efforts often involve assets that, if acquired, would have a material effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We also evaluate from time to time possible dispositions of assets or businesses when such assets or businesses are no longer core to our operations and do not fit into our long-term strategy.

The Amended Credit Agreement contains a number of covenants that, among other things, limit or restrict the ability of the Company and its subsidiaries to dispose of assets, make acquisitions and engage in mergers. See “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Debt.”

 

18


Table of Contents

Environmental Matters

The operation of our business is subject to stringent and complex laws and regulations pertaining to health, safety and the environment. As an owner or operator of manufacturing facilities, we must comply with these laws and regulations at the federal, state and local levels. These laws and regulations can restrict or impact our business activities in many ways, such as:

 

   

requiring investigative or remedial action to mitigate or address certain environmental conditions that may have been caused by our operations or practices, or attributable to former owners or operators; and

 

   

enjoining or restricting the operations of facilities found to be out of compliance with environmental laws and regulations or permits issued pursuant to such laws or regulations.

Failure to comply with these laws and regulations may trigger a variety of administrative, civil or criminal enforcement measures, including the assessment of monetary penalties, the imposition of investigative or remedial requirements, the issuance of orders enjoining or limiting current or future operations, or the denial or revocation of permits or other legal authorizations. Certain environmental statutes impose strict, joint and several liability for costs required to clean up and restore sites where hazardous substances have been disposed of or otherwise released. Moreover, neighboring landowners and other third parties may file claims for personal injury and property damage allegedly caused by the release of substances or contaminants into the environment.

The trend in environmental regulation is to place more restrictions and limitations on activities that potentially affect human health, welfare or the environment. As a result, there can be no assurance as to the amount or timing of future expenditures for environmental compliance or remediation, and actual future expenditures may differ from what we currently anticipate. However, we anticipate future regulatory requirements that might be imposed and plan accordingly to meet and maintain compliance with such environmental laws and regulations, and to minimize the associated costs of such compliance while not encroaching on our ability to comply.

We do not believe that compliance with federal, state or local environmental laws and regulations will have a material adverse effect on our business, financial position or results of operations. In addition, we believe that the various environmental activities we are presently engaged in are not expected to materially interrupt or diminish our operational ability to manufacture our products. We cannot assure you, however, that future events, such as changes in existing laws, the promulgation of new laws, or the development or discovery of new facts or conditions related to our operations will not cause us to incur significant costs.

The following is a discussion of some environmental and safety requirements that relate to our business:

Air Emissions. Our operations are subject to the federal Clean Air Act Amendments of 1990, or CAAA, and comparable state laws and regulations. These laws and regulations govern emissions of air pollutants from various industrial sources, including our manufacturing facilities, and impose various monitoring and reporting requirements. Such laws and regulations may require that we: obtain pre-approval for the construction or modification of certain projects or facilities with the potential to produce air emissions or cause an increase of existing air emissions; obtain and strictly comply with operating permits that specify various air emissions and operational limitations; or utilize specific emission control technologies to limit or reduce emissions from our facilities. Our failure to comply with these requirements could subject us to monetary penalties, injunctions, conditions or restrictions on operations, and, potentially, civil or criminal enforcement actions. We may be required to incur certain capital and other expenditures in the future for air pollution control equipment in connection with obtaining and complying with operating permits and authorizations for air emissions. We believe, however, that our operations will not be materially adversely affected by such requirements.

Greenhouse Gases. More stringent laws and regulations relating to climate change and greenhouse gases, or GHGs, may be adopted in the future and could cause us to incur additional operating costs or reduce the demand

 

19


Table of Contents

for our products. On December 15, 2009, the federal Environmental Protection Agency, or EPA, published its findings that emissions of carbon dioxide, methane, and other GHGs present an endangerment to public health and the environment because emissions of such gases are, according to the EPA, contributing to the warming of the earth’s atmosphere and other climate changes. These findings allow the EPA to adopt and implement regulations that would restrict emissions of GHGs under existing provisions of the federal CAAA. The EPA has adopted regulations that would require a reduction in emissions of GHGs and could trigger permit review for GHGs produced from certain industrial stationary sources. In June 2010, the EPA adopted the Prevention of Significant Deterioration and Title V Greenhouse Gas Tailoring Rule, which phases in permitting requirements for stationary sources of GHGs beginning January 2, 2011. This rule “tailors” these permitting programs to apply to certain significant stationary sources of GHG emissions in a multistep process, with the largest sources first subject to permitting. In addition, EPA has issued regulations requiring the reporting of GHG emissions from certain significant sources of GHG emission sources in the United States beginning in 2011 for emissions occurring in 2010. These requirements could increase the cost of doing business for us and our suppliers, including increasing the cost of steel and energy, and thus adversely affect the demand for our products. We believe, however, that our operations will not be materially adversely affected by such requirements.

In addition, both houses of Congress have actively considered legislation to reduce emissions of GHGs, and more than one-third of the states have already taken legal measures to reduce emissions of GHGs, primarily through the planned development of GHG emission inventories and/or regional GHG cap and trade programs. Most of these cap and trade programs work by requiring either major sources of emissions or major producers of fuels to acquire and surrender emission allowances, with the number of allowances available for purchase reduced each year until an overall GHG emission reduction goal is achieved. Although it is not possible at this time to predict how legislation or new regulations that may be adopted to address GHG emissions would impact our business, any new federal, regional or state restrictions on emissions of carbon dioxide or other GHGs that may be imposed in areas where we conduct business could result in increased compliance costs or additional operating restrictions on us and our raw material suppliers. Such restrictions could potentially make our products more expensive and thus reduce their demand, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Hazardous and Solid Industrial Waste. Our operations generate industrial wastes, including some hazardous wastes that are subject to the federal Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, or RCRA, and comparable state laws, which impose detailed requirements for the handling, storage, treatment and disposal of hazardous and solid industrial waste. For example, industrial wastes such as paint waste, spent solvents, and waste oils may be regulated as hazardous waste. RCRA currently exempts many of our manufacturing wastes from classification as hazardous waste. However, these non-hazardous or exempted industrial wastes are still regulated under state law or the less stringent industrial solid waste requirements of RCRA. We do not believe that our operations will be materially adversely affected by such requirements.

Site Remediation. The Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, as amended, or CERCLA, and comparable state laws impose liability, without regard to fault or the legality of the original conduct, on certain classes of persons responsible for the release of hazardous substances into the environment. Such classes of persons include the current and past owners or operators of sites where a hazardous substance was released, and companies that disposed or arranged for disposal of hazardous substances at off-site locations such as landfills. In the course of our ordinary operations we generate industrial wastes that may fall within the definition of a “hazardous substance.” CERCLA authorizes the EPA and, in some cases, third parties to take actions in response to threats to the public health or the environment and to seek to recover from the responsible classes of persons the costs incurred for remedial activities or other corrective actions. Under CERCLA, we could be subject to joint and several liability for the costs of cleaning up and restoring sites where hazardous substances have been released for damages to natural resources, and for the costs of certain risk assessment studies.

We currently own or lease, and have in the past owned or leased, numerous properties that for many years have been used for manufacturing operations. Hazardous substances or industrial wastes may have been disposed of or released on or under the properties owned or leased by us, or on or under other locations where such wastes

 

20


Table of Contents

have been taken for disposal. In addition, some of these properties have been operated by third parties or by previous owners whose treatment and disposal or release of hazardous substances or wastes was not under our control. These properties and the substances disposed or released on them may be subject to CERCLA, RCRA and analogous state laws. Under such laws, we could be required to remove previously disposed wastes (including waste disposed by prior owners or operators), investigate or remediate contaminated property (including soil and groundwater contamination, whether from prior owners or operators or other historic activities or releases), or perform remedial closure operations to prevent future contamination. Moreover, neighboring landowners and other affected parties may file claims for personal injury and property damage allegedly caused by the release of hazardous substances into the environment.

Wastewater Discharges. Our operations are subject to the federal Water Pollution Control Act of 1972, as amended, also known as the Clean Water Act, and analogous state laws and regulations. These laws and regulations impose detailed requirements and strict controls regarding the discharge of pollutants from industrial activity into waters of the United States. Such laws and regulations may require that we obtain and strictly comply with categorical industrial waste water standards and discharge permits containing limits on various water pollutant and discharge parameters. Our failure to comply with these requirements could subject us to monetary penalties, injunctions, conditions or restrictions on operations, and, potentially, civil or criminal enforcement actions. We may be required to incur certain capital and other expenditures in the future for wastewater treatment equipment in connection with maintaining compliance with wastewater discharge permits and water quality standards. Any unauthorized release of pollutants to waters of the United States from our facilities could result in administrative, civil and criminal fines or penalties as well as associated remedial obligations. We believe, however, that our operations will not be materially adversely affected by such requirements.

Employee Health and Safety. We are subject to the requirements of the Occupational Safety and Health Act, or OSHA, and comparable state laws that regulate the protection of the health and safety of our workers. In addition, the OSHA hazard communication standard requires that information be maintained about hazardous materials used or produced in our operations and is available to our employees, state and local government authorities, and citizens. We believe that we are in compliance with these requirements and that our operations will not be materially adversely affected by such requirements.

Zoning and Building Code Requirements

The engineered building systems and components we manufacture must meet zoning, building code and uplift requirements adopted by local governmental agencies. We believe that our products are in substantial compliance with applicable zoning, code and uplift requirements. Compliance does not have a material adverse effect on our business.

Patents, Licenses and Proprietary Rights

We have a number of United States patents, pending patent applications and other proprietary rights, including those relating to metal roofing systems, metal overhead doors, our pier and header system, our Long Bay® System and our building estimating and design system. The patent on our Long Bay® System expires in 2020. We also have several registered trademarks and pending registrations in the United States.

Research and Development Costs

Total expenditures for research and development were $1.3 million, $1.1 million and $1.0 million for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. We incur research and development costs to develop new products, improve existing products and improve safety factors of our products in the metal components segment. These products include building and roofing systems, panels, clips, purlins, and fasteners.

 

21


Table of Contents

Employees

As of October 30, 2011, we had approximately 3,590 employees, of whom 2,042 were manufacturing and engineering personnel. We regard our employee relations as satisfactory. Approximately 11.2% of our workforce, including the employees at our subsidiary in Mexico, are represented by a collective bargaining agreement or union.

Item 1A. Risk Factors.

Our industry is cyclical and highly sensitive to macroeconomic conditions; as a result, our industry is currently experiencing a downturn which, if sustained, will materially and adversely affect our business, liquidity and results of operations.

The nonresidential construction industry is highly sensitive to national and regional macroeconomic conditions. The United States and global economies are currently undergoing a period of slowdown and unprecedented volatility, which is having an adverse effect on our business.

When assessing the state of the metal construction market, we review information from various industry associations, third-party research, and various government reports such as industrial production and capacity utilization. One such industry association is the MBMA, which provides summary member sales information and promotes the design and construction of metal buildings and metal roofing systems. Another is McGraw-Hill Construction Information Group, which we review for information regarding actual and forecasted growth in various construction related industries, including the overall nonresidential construction market. McGraw-Hill Construction’s nonresidential construction forecast for calendar 2011, updated in October 2011, indicates an expected reduction of 4% in square footage and a decrease of 6% in dollar value as compared to the prior calendar year. In calendar 2012, activity is expected to increase compared to calendar 2011, with an expected increase of 2% in square footage and an increase of 2% in dollar value. Additionally, we review the AIA survey for inquiry and billing activity for the industrial, commercial and institutional sectors. AIA’s ABI is a closely watched metric, as billing growth for architectural services generally leads to construction spending growth 9 to 12 months forward. An ABI reading above 50 indicates an increase in month-to-month billings and a reading below 50 indicates a decrease in month-to-month billings. AIA’s ABI published for October 2011 was below 50 at 49.4 but the commercial and industrial component of the index was at 53.5 for October 2011, the second consecutive month above 50.

Continued uncertainty about current economic conditions has had a negative effect on our business, and will continue to pose a risk to our business as our customers may postpone spending in response to tighter credit, negative financial news and/or declines in income or asset values, which could have a material negative effect on the demand for our products. Other factors that could influence demand include fuel and other energy costs, conditions in the nonresidential real estate markets, labor and healthcare costs, access to credit and other macroeconomic factors. From time to time, our industry has also been adversely affected in various parts of the country by declines in nonresidential construction starts, including but not limited to, high vacancy rates, changes in tax laws affecting the real estate industry, high interest rates and the unavailability of financing. Sales of our products may be adversely affected by continued weakness in demand for our products within particular customer groups, or a continued decline in the general construction industry or particular geographic regions. These and other economic factors could have a material adverse effect on demand for our products and on our financial condition and operating results.

We cannot predict the ultimate severity or length of the current economic downturn, or the timing or severity of future economic or industry downturns. A prolonged economic downturn, particularly in states where many of our sales are made, would have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition, including potential asset impairments, including the realizability of our deferred tax asset.

 

22


Table of Contents

We may not be able to service our debt, obtain future financing or may be limited operationally.

The debt that we carry may have important consequences to us, including the following:

 

   

Our ability to obtain additional financing, if necessary, for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions or other purposes may be impaired or additional financing may not be available on favorable terms;

 

   

We must use a portion of our cash flow to pay the principal and interest on our debt. These payments reduce the funds that would otherwise be available for our operations and future business opportunities;

 

   

A substantial decrease in our net operating cash flows could make it difficult for us to meet our debt service requirements and force us to modify our operations; and

 

   

We may be more vulnerable to a downturn in our business or the economy generally.

If we cannot service our debt, we will be forced to take actions such as reducing or delaying acquisitions and/or capital expenditures, selling assets, restructuring or refinancing our debt or seeking additional equity capital. We can give you no assurance that we can do any of these things on satisfactory terms or at all.

Subject to restrictions in our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility, we may incur substantial additional debt from time to time to finance acquisitions, capital expenditures or for other purposes.

Restrictive covenants in the Amended Credit Agreement and the ABL Facility may adversely affect us.

We must comply with operating and financing restrictions in the Amended Credit Agreement and the ABL Facility. We may also have similar restrictions with any future debt. These restrictions affect, and in many respects limit or prevent us from:

 

   

incurring additional indebtedness;

 

   

making restricted payments, including dividends or other distributions;

 

   

incurring liens;

 

   

making investments, including joint venture investments;

 

   

selling assets;

 

   

repurchasing our debt and our capital stock; and

 

   

merging or consolidating with or into other companies or sell substantially all our assets.

We are required to make mandatory payments under the Amended Credit Agreement upon the occurrence of certain events, including the sale of assets and the issuance of debt, in each case subject to certain limitations and conditions set forth in our Amended Credit Agreement. The Amended Credit Agreement also requires us, beginning with the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011, to satisfy set financial tests relating to our leverage ratio, provided that these financial tests will not apply to any fiscal quarter in which certain amortization targets are met. In fiscal 2011, we made optional prepayments in the amount of $5.6 million. These prepayments have deferred our leverage ratio covenant until the first quarter of fiscal 2013. In May 2010, we made a mandatory prepayment on the Amended Credit Agreement in the amount of $13.3 million in connection with our tax refund received resulting from the carry back of the 2009 net operating loss. These prepayments are allowed to be applied against the remaining quarterly principal payments and, as a result, we are not required to make any additional quarterly principal payments for the remainder of the term loan.

Under the ABL Facility, a “Dominion Event” occurs if either an event of default is continuing or excess availability falls below certain levels, during which period, and for certain periods thereafter, the administrative agent may apply all amounts in the Company’s concentration account to the repayment of the loans outstanding

 

23


Table of Contents

under the ABL Facility, subject to an intercreditor agreement between the lenders under the Amended Credit Agreement and the ABL Facility. In addition, during a Dominion Event, we are required to make mandatory payments on the ABL Facility upon the occurrence of certain events, including the sale of assets and the issuance of debt, in each case subject to certain limitations and conditions set forth in the ABL Facility. If excess availability under the ABL Facility falls below certain levels, our asset-based loan facility also requires us to satisfy set financial tests relating to our fixed charge coverage ratio.

These restrictions could limit our ability to plan for or react to market conditions or meet extraordinary capital needs or otherwise could restrict our activities. In addition, under certain circumstances and subject to the limitations set forth in the Amended Credit Agreement, the Amended Credit Agreement requires us to pay down our term loan to the extent we generate positive cash flow each fiscal year. These restrictions could also adversely affect our ability to finance our future operations or capital needs or to engage in other business activities that would be in our interest.

We may recognize goodwill or other intangible asset impairment charges.

Future triggering events, such as declines in our cash flow projections, may cause impairments of our goodwill or intangible assets based on factors such as our stock price, projected cash flows, assumptions used, control premiums or other variables.

We completed our annual assessment of the recoverability of goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 and determined that no impairments of our goodwill or long-lived intangibles were required.

Our businesses are seasonal, and our results of operations during our first two fiscal quarters may be adversely affected by seasonality.

The metal coil coating, metal components and engineered building systems businesses, and the construction industry in general, are seasonal in nature. Sales normally are lower in the first calendar quarter of each year compared to the other three quarters because of unfavorable weather conditions for construction and typical business planning cycles affecting construction. This seasonality adversely affects our results of operations for the first two fiscal quarters. Prolonged severe weather conditions can delay construction projects and otherwise adversely affect our business.

Price volatility and supply constraints in the steel market could prevent us from meeting delivery schedules to our customers or reduce our profit margins.

Our business is heavily dependent on the price and supply of steel. The steel industry is highly cyclical in nature, and steel prices have been volatile in recent years and may remain volatile in the future. Steel prices are influenced by numerous factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions domestically and internationally, the availability of raw materials, competition, labor costs, freight and transportation costs, production costs, import duties and other trade restrictions. Given the level of steel industry consolidation, the anticipated additional domestic market capacity, generally low inventories in the industry and slow economic recovery, a sudden increase in demand could affect our ability to purchase steel and result in rapidly increasing steel prices.

We do not have any long-term contracts for the purchase of steel and normally do not maintain an inventory of steel in excess of our current production requirements. However, from time to time, we may purchase steel in advance of announced steel price increases. In addition, it is our current practice to purchase all consignment inventory that remains in consignment after an agreed term. Therefore, our inventory may increase if demand for our products declines. We can give you no assurance that steel will remain available or that prices will not continue to be volatile. While most of our sales contracts have escalation clauses that allow us, under certain

 

24


Table of Contents

circumstances, to pass along all or a portion of increases in the price of steel after the date of the contract but prior to delivery, we may, for competitive or other reasons, not be able to pass such price increases along. If the available supply of steel declines, we could experience price increases that we are not able to pass on to our customers, a deterioration of service from our suppliers or interruptions or delays that may cause us not to meet delivery schedules to our customers. Any of these problems could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. For more information about steel pricing trends in recent years, see “Item 1. Business — Raw Materials” and “Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk — Steel Prices.”

We rely on a few major suppliers for our supply of steel, which makes us more vulnerable to supply constraints and pricing pressure, as well as the financial condition of those suppliers.

We rely on a few major suppliers for our supply of steel and may be adversely affected by the bankruptcy, financial condition or other factors affecting those suppliers. During fiscal 2011, we purchased approximately 33% of our steel requirements from two vendors in the United States. No other vendor accounted for over 10% of our steel requirements during fiscal 2011. Due to unfavorable market conditions and our inventory supply requirements during fiscal 2011, we purchased insignificant amounts of steel from foreign suppliers. Limiting purchases to domestic suppliers further reduces our available steel supply base. Therefore, production cutbacks or a prolonged labor strike against one or more of our principal domestic suppliers could have a material adverse effect on our operations. Furthermore, if one or more of our current suppliers is unable for financial or any other reason to continue in business or to produce steel sufficient to meet our requirements, essential supply of our primary raw materials could be temporarily interrupted, and our business could be adversely affected.

Failure to retain or replace key personnel could hurt our operations.

Our success depends to a significant degree upon the efforts, contributions and abilities of our senior management, plant managers and other highly skilled personnel, including our sales executives. These executives and managers have many accumulated years of experience in our industry and have developed personal relationships with our customers that are important to our business. If we do not retain the services of our key personnel or if we fail to adequately plan for the succession of such individuals, our customer relationships, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

If we are unable to enforce our intellectual property rights or if our intellectual property rights become obsolete, our competitive position could be adversely affected.

We utilize a variety of intellectual property rights in our services. We have a number of United States patents, foreign patents, pending patent applications and other proprietary rights, including those relating to metal roofing systems, metal overhead doors, our pier and header system, our Long Bay® System and our building estimating and design system. We also have several registered trademarks and pending registrations in the United States. We view our portfolio of process and design technologies as one of our competitive strengths. We may not be able to successfully preserve these intellectual property rights in the future and these rights could be invalidated, circumvented, or challenged. If we are unable to protect and maintain our intellectual property rights, or if there are any successful intellectual property challenges or infringement proceedings against us, our business and revenue could be materially and adversely affected.

We incur costs to comply with environmental laws and have liabilities for environmental investigations, cleanups and claims.

Because we emit and discharge pollutants into the environment, own and operate real property that has historically been used for industrial purposes, and generate and handle hazardous substances and waste, we incur costs and liabilities to comply with environmental laws and regulations. We may incur significant additional costs as those laws and regulations or their enforcement change in the future, if there is a release of hazardous substances into the environment or if a historical release of hazardous substances or other contamination is

 

25


Table of Contents

identified. The operations of our manufacturing facilities are subject to stringent and complex federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations. These include, for example, (i) the federal Clean Air Act and comparable state laws and regulations that impose obligations related to air emissions, (ii) the federal RCRA and comparable state laws that impose requirements for the storage, treatment, handling and disposal of waste from our facilities and (iii) CERCLA and comparable state laws that impose liability for the investigation and cleanup of hazardous substances that may have been released at properties currently or previously owned or operated by us or locations to which we have sent waste for disposal. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations may trigger a variety of administrative, civil and criminal enforcement measures, including the assessment of monetary penalties, the imposition of investigative or remedial requirements, personal injury, property or natural resource damages claims and the issuance of orders enjoining current or future operations, or the denial or revocation of permits or other authorizations. For more information about the effect of environmental laws and regulations on our business, see “Item 1. Business — Environmental Matters.”

The industries in which we operate are highly competitive.

We compete with all other alternative methods of building construction, which may be viewed as more traditional, more aesthetically pleasing or having other advantages over our products. In addition, competition in the metal components and metal buildings markets of the building industry and in the metal coil coating segment is intense. It is based primarily on:

 

   

quality;

 

   

service;

 

   

on-time delivery;

 

   

ability to provide added value in the design and engineering of buildings;

 

   

price;

 

   

speed of construction in buildings and components; and

 

   

personal relationships with customers.

We compete with a number of other manufacturers of metal components and engineered building systems and providers of coil coating services ranging from small local firms to large national firms. In addition, we and other manufacturers of metal components and engineered building systems compete with alternative methods of building construction. If these alternative building methods compete successfully against us, such competition could adversely affect us.

In addition, several of our competitors have been acquired by steel producers. Competitors owned by steel producers may have a competitive advantage on raw materials that we do not enjoy. Steel producers may prioritize deliveries of raw materials to such competitors or provide them with more favorable pricing, both of which could enable them to offer products to customers at lower prices or accelerated delivery schedules.

Our stock price has been and may continue to be volatile.

The trading price of our common stock has fluctuated in the past and is subject to significant fluctuations in response to the following factors, some of which are beyond our control:

 

   

variations in quarterly operating results;

 

   

deviations in our earnings from publicly disclosed forward-looking guidance;

 

   

declines in our revenues;

 

   

changes in earnings estimates by analysts;

 

   

our announcements of significant contracts, acquisitions, strategic partnerships or joint ventures;

 

26


Table of Contents
   

general conditions in the metal components and engineered building systems industries;

 

   

uncertainty about current global economic conditions;

 

   

fluctuations in stock market price and volume; and

 

   

other general economic conditions.

During fiscal 2011, our stock price on the New York Stock Exchange ranged from a high of approximately $15.15 per share to a low of $6.80 per share. In recent years, the stock market in general has experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have affected the market price for many companies in industries similar to ours. Some of these fluctuations have been unrelated to the operating performance of the affected companies. These market fluctuations may decrease the market price of our common stock in the future.

We may face liability as a result of the sale of unregistered shares of our common stock to participants in the Company’s 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan.

Under federal securities laws, shares of Company Common Stock to be purchased on behalf of participants in our 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan (the “Plan”) are required to be registered with the SEC or sold in transactions that are exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933. On February 7, 2011, the Company discovered that it inadvertently issued more shares of the Company’s Common Stock in connection with the Plan than had been registered with the SEC. As a result, certain participants in the Plan who purchased shares in the unregistered transactions may have the right to rescind their purchases for an amount equal to the price of the shares (or if the shares have been disposed of, to receive damages with respect to any loss on such disposition) plus interest, less income, from the date of purchase. At October 30, 2011, approximately 0.1 million shares ($0.8 million) of the Company’s Common Stock were classified outside stockholders’ equity as redeemable common stock because of the potential rescission rights. We have determined that the potential damage claims with respect to unregistered Company Common Stock are related to purchases made under the Plan between October 31, 2010 and February 15, 2011. In addition, we may be subject to civil and other penalties by regulatory authorities as a result of the failure to register. We cannot be certain what, if any, claims or actions may be brought against us as a result of this matter.

Acquisitions may be unsuccessful if we incorrectly predict operating results or are unable to identify and complete future acquisitions and integrate acquired assets or businesses.

We have a history of expansion through acquisitions, and we believe that if our industry continues to consolidate, our future success may depend, in part, on our ability to successfully complete acquisitions. Growing through acquisitions and managing that growth will require us to continue to invest in operational, financial and management information systems and to attract, retain, motivate and effectively manage our employees. Pursuing and integrating acquisitions involves a number of risks, including:

 

   

the risk of incorrect assumptions or estimates regarding the future results of the acquired business or expected cost reductions or other synergies expected to be realized as a result of acquiring the business;

 

   

diversion of management’s attention from existing operations;

 

   

unexpected losses of key employees, customers and suppliers of the acquired business;

 

   

integrating the financial, technological and management standards, processes, procedures and controls of the acquired business with those of our existing operations; and

 

   

increasing the scope, geographic diversity and complexity of our operations.

Although the majority of our growth strategy is organic in nature, if we do pursue opportunistic acquisitions, we can provide no assurance that we will be successful in identifying or completing any acquisitions or that any businesses or assets that we are able to acquire will be successfully integrated into our existing business. We cannot predict the effect, if any, that any announcement or consummation of an acquisition would have on the trading prices of our securities.

 

27


Table of Contents

Acquisitions subject us to numerous risks that could adversely affect our results of operations.

If we pursue further acquisitions, depending on conditions in the acquisition market, it may be difficult or impossible for us to identify businesses or operations for acquisition, or we may not be able to make acquisitions on terms that we consider economically acceptable. Even if we are able to identify suitable acquisition opportunities, our acquisition strategy depends upon, among other things, our ability to obtain financing and, in some cases, regulatory approvals, including under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Act.

Our incurrence of additional debt, contingent liabilities and expenses in connection with any future acquisitions could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Furthermore, our financial position and results of operations may fluctuate significantly from period to period based on whether significant acquisitions are completed in particular periods. Competition for acquisitions is intense and may increase the cost of, or cause us to refrain from, completing acquisitions.

The Convertible Preferred Stock will be dilutive to our stockholders. The Convertible Preferred Stock accrues dividends, which may be paid in cash or in-kind. If dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock are paid in-kind, they will dilute the ownership interest of our stockholders. In addition, the dividend rate of the Convertible Preferred Stock will increase upon the occurrence of certain events which constitute defaults under the terms of the Convertible Preferred Stock, which may cause further dilution. Furthermore, the Convertible Preferred Stock also provides for anti-dilution rights, which may dilute the ownership interest of stockholders in the future.

Dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock are payable, on a cumulative daily basis, as and if declared by the our board of directors, at a rate per annum of 12% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus accrued and unpaid dividends thereon or at a rate per annum of 8% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon if paid in cash on the dividend payment date on which such dividends would otherwise compound. If dividends are not declared in cash or in-kind, such dividends compound on the dividend payment date. If dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock are paid in-kind, it will dilute the ownership interest of stockholders.

On September 6, 2011, we entered into a Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock, agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended September 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares (the “Certificate of Designations”), and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the remainder of its fiscal year ending October 30, 2011, subject to certain exceptions.

The September 6, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after September 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 30, 2011.

On December 9, 2011, we entered into a second Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock, agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended December 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares, and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the fiscal year ending October 28, 2012, subject to certain exceptions.

 

28


Table of Contents

The December 9, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after December 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 28, 2012.

The dividend rate will increase by up to 6% per annum above the rates described in the preceding paragraph upon and during certain defaults specified in the Certificate of Designations involving the Company’s failure to have a number of authorized and unissued shares of Common Stock reserved and available sufficient for the conversion of all outstanding Preferred Shares. The Company currently has sufficient authorized, unissued and reserved shares of Common Stock.

On the dividend payment date, we have the right to choose whether dividends are paid in cash or in-kind. However, the first dividend payment which was scheduled to be paid on December 15, 2009 in the amount of $4.6 million, was required to be paid in cash by the Certificate of Designations but could not be paid in cash based on the terms of our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility which restricted the Company’s ability to pay cash dividends until the first quarter of fiscal 2011 and until October 20, 2010, respectively. As a result, the dividend for the period up to the December 15, 2009 dividend payment date compounded at a rate of 12% per annum. We currently cannot pay this dividend in cash because the Company’s Amended Credit Agreement currently restricts the payment of cash dividends to 50% of cumulative earnings beginning with the fourth quarter of 2009, and in the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan of which we used $11.0 million as of October 30, 2011. Each quarterly dividend payment cannot be split between cash and payment-in-kind.

In addition to any dividends declared and paid as described in the preceding paragraphs, holders of the outstanding Preferred Shares also have the right to participate equally and ratably, on an as-converted basis, with the holders of shares of Common Stock in all cash dividends and distributions paid on the Common Stock.

If, at any time after the 30-month anniversary of the Closing Date of October 20, 2009 (i.e., March 20, 2012), the trading price of the Common Stock exceeds $12.75 which is 200% of the initial conversion price of the Convertible Preferred Stock ($6.3740, as adjusted for any stock dividends, splits, combinations or similar events) for each of 20 consecutive trading days (the “Dividend Rate Reduction Event”), the dividend rate (excluding any applicable adjustments as a result of a default) will become 0.00%. However, this does not preclude the payment of default dividends after the 30-month anniversary of the Closing Date.

The conversion price of the Convertible Preferred Stock is subject to adjustment, including if the Company issues common stock or other securities below the then-current market price or, during the first three years after October 20, 2009, below the then-current conversion price. Adjustments to the conversion price will dilute the ownership interest of stockholders.

In connection with the Equity Investment, we entered into a stockholders agreement with the CD&R Funds pursuant to which the CD&R Funds have substantial governance and other rights and setting forth certain terms and conditions regarding the Equity Investment and the ownership of the CD&R Funds’ shares of Convertible Preferred Stock.

Pursuant to the stockholders agreement with the CD&R Funds, subject to certain ownership and other requirements and conditions, the CD&R Funds have the right to appoint a majority of directors to our board of directors, including the “Lead Director” or Chairman of the Executive Committee of our board of directors, and have consent rights over a variety of significant corporate and financing matters, including, subject to certain customary exceptions and specified baskets, sales and acquisitions of assets, issuances and redemptions of equity, incurrence of debt, the declaration or payment of extraordinary distributions or dividends and changes to the Company’s line of business. In addition, the CD&R Funds are granted subscription rights under the terms and conditions of the stockholders agreement.

 

29


Table of Contents

Further, effective as of the closing of the Equity Investment, the Company has taken all corporate action and filed all election notices or other documentation with the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) necessary to elect to take advantage of the exemptions to the requirements of sections 303A.01, 303A.04 and 303A.05 of the NYSE Listed Company Manual and, for so long as we qualify as a “controlled company” within the meaning set forth in the NYSE Listed Company Manual or any similar provision in the rules of a stock exchange on which the securities of the Company are quoted or listed for trading, we have agreed to use our reasonable best efforts to take advantage of the exemptions therein. Such exemptions exempt us from compliance with the NYSE’s requirements for companies listed on the NYSE to have (1) a majority of independent directors, (2) a nominating/corporate governance committee and a compensation committee, in each case, composed entirely of independent directors, and (3) charters for the nominating/corporate governance committee and the compensation committee, in each case, addressing certain specified matters.

The Convertible Preferred Stock issued in connection with the Equity Investment has substantial rights and ranks senior to the common stock.

Shares of our common stock rank junior as to dividend rights, redemption payments and rights (including as to distribution of assets) in any liquidation, dissolution, or winding-up of the affairs of the Company and otherwise to the shares of Convertible Preferred Stock issued to the CD&R Funds in connection with the Equity Investment. The terms of the Convertible Preferred Stock entitle the holders thereof to vote on an as-converted basis (without taking into account any limitations on convertibility that may then be applicable) with the holders of common stock. The CD&R Funds have a majority voting position and holders of common stock are in the minority. In addition, certain actions by the Company, including, upon the occurrence of certain specified defaults, the adoption of an annual budget, the hiring and firing, or the changing of the compensation, of executive officers and the commitment, resolution or agreement to effect any business combination, among others, require the prior affirmative vote or written consent of the holders representing at least a majority of the then-outstanding shares of Convertible Preferred Stock, voting together as a separate class. This level of control, together with the CD&R Funds’ rights under the stockholders agreement, could discourage others from initiating any potential merger, takeover or other change of control transaction that may otherwise be beneficial to our business or our stockholders.

Furthermore, the terms of the Convertible Preferred Stock provide for anti-dilution rights, which may dilute the ownership interest of stockholders in the future, and change of control redemption rights, which may entitle the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock to receive higher value for their shares of Convertible Preferred Stock than the shares of common stock would receive in the event of a change of control. In addition, the terms of the Convertible Preferred Stock also provide that the CD&R Funds participate in common stock dividends, receive preferred dividends and have preferential rights in liquidation, including make-whole rights.

Increases in energy prices will increase our operating costs, and we may be unable to pass all these increases on to our customers in the form of higher prices for our products.

Increases in energy prices will increase our operating costs and may reduce our profitability and cash flows if we are unable to pass all the increases on to our customers. We use energy in the manufacture and transport of our products. In particular, our manufacturing plants use considerable electricity and natural gas. Consequently, our operating costs typically increase if energy costs rise. During periods of higher energy costs, we may not be able to recover our operating cost increases through price increases without reducing demand for our products. To the extent we are not able to recover these cost increases through price increases or otherwise, our profitability and cash flow will be adversely impacted. We partially hedge our exposure to higher prices via fixed forward positions.

 

30


Table of Contents

The adoption of climate change legislation or regulations restricting emissions of greenhouse gases could increase our operating costs or reduce demand for our products.

More stringent laws and regulations relating to climate change and GHGs may be adopted in the future and could cause us to incur additional operating costs or reduce the demand for our products. On December 15, 2009, the EPA published its findings that emissions of carbon dioxide, methane, and other GHGs present an endangerment to public health and the environment because emissions of such gases are, according to the federal Environmental Protection Agency, or EPA, contributing to the warming of the earth’s atmosphere and other climate changes. These findings allow the EPA to adopt and implement regulations that would restrict emissions of GHGs under existing provisions of the federal Clean Air Act. The EPA has adopted regulations that would require a reduction in emissions of GHGs and could trigger permit review for GHGs produced from certain stationary sources. In June 2010, EPA adopted the Prevention of Significant Deterioration and Title V Greenhouse Gas Tailoring Rule, which phases in permitting requirements for stationary sources of GHGs, beginning January 2, 2011. This rule “tailors” these permitting programs to apply to certain significant stationary sources of GHG emissions in a multi-step process, with the largest sources first subject to permitting. In addition, EPA has issued regulations requiring the reporting of GHG emissions from certain, significant sources of GHG emission sources in the United States beginning in 2011 for emissions occurring in 2010. These requirements could increase the cost of doing business for us and our suppliers, including increasing the cost of steel and energy, and adversely affect the demand for our products.

In addition, both houses of Congress have actively considered legislation to reduce emissions of GHGs, and more than one-third of the states have already taken legal measures to reduce emissions of GHGs, primarily through the planned development of GHG emission inventories and/or regional GHG cap and trade programs. Most of these cap and trade programs work by requiring either major sources of emissions or major producers of fuels to acquire and surrender emission allowances, with the number of allowances available for purchase reduced each year until an overall GHG emission reduction goal is achieved. Although it is not possible at this time to predict how legislation or new regulations that may be adopted to address GHG emissions would impact our business, any new federal, regional or state restrictions on emissions of carbon dioxide or other GHGs that may be imposed in areas where we conduct business could result in increased compliance costs or additional operating restrictions on us and our raw material suppliers. Such restrictions could potentially make our products more expensive and thus reduce their demand, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Breaches of our information system security measures could disrupt our internal operations.

We are dependent upon information technology for the distribution of information internally and also to our customers and suppliers. This information technology is subject to theft, damage or interruption from a variety of sources, including but not limited to malicious computer viruses, security breaches and defects in design. Various measures have been implemented to manage our risks related to information system and network disruptions, but a system failure or breach of these measures could negatively impact our operations and financial results.

Our operations are subject to hazards that may cause personal injury or property damage, thereby subjecting us to liabilities and possible losses, which may not be covered by insurance.

Our workers are subject to the usual hazards associated with work in manufacturing environments. Operating hazards can cause personal injury and loss of life, as well as damage to or destruction of business personal property, and possible environmental impairment. We are subject to either deductible or self-insured retention (SIR) amounts, per claim or occurrence, under our Property/Casualty insurance programs, as well as an individual stop-loss limit per claim under our group medical insurance plan. We maintain insurance coverage to transfer risk, with aggregate and per-occurrence limits and deductible or retention levels that we believe are consistent with industry practice. The transfer of risk through insurance cannot guarantee that coverage will be available for every loss or liability that we may incur in our operations.

Exposures that could create insured (or uninsured) liabilities are difficult to assess and quantify due to unknown factors, including but not limited to injury frequency and severity, natural disasters, terrorism threats,

 

31


Table of Contents

third-party liability, and claims that are incurred but not reported (IBNR). Although we engage third-party actuarial professionals to assist us in determining our probable future loss exposure, it is possible that claims or costs could exceed our estimates or our insurance limits, or could be uninsurable. In such instances we might be required to use working capital to satisfy these losses rather than to maintain or expand our operations, which could materially and adversely affect our operating results and our financial condition.

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments.

There are no unresolved staff comments outstanding with the Securities and Exchange Commission at this time.

Item 2. Properties.

As of October 30, 2011, we conduct manufacturing operations at the following facilities.

 

Facility

  

Products

   Square
Feet
     Owned or
Leased
 

Domestic:

        

Chandler, Arizona

   Doors and related metal components      37,975         Leased   

Tolleson, Arizona

   Metal components(1)      70,956         Owned   

Atwater, California

   Engineered building systems(2)      219,870         Owned   

Rancho Cucamonga, California

   Metal coil coating      111,611         Owned   

Adel, Georgia

   Metal components(1)      78,809         Owned   

Lithia Springs, Georgia

   Metal components(3)      125,081         Owned   

Douglasville, Georgia

   Doors and related metal components      83,775         Owned   

Marietta, Georgia

   Metal coil coating      194,836         Leased   

Shelbyville, Indiana

   Metal components(1)      71,734         Owned   

Monticello, Iowa

   Engineered building systems(4)      232,560         Owned   

Oskaloosa, Iowa

   Metal components(5)      74,771         Owned   

Nicholasville, Kentucky

   Metal components(5)      26,943         Owned   

Jackson, Mississippi

   Metal components(8)      171,790         Owned   

Jackson, Mississippi

   Metal coil coating      354,350         Owned   

Hernando, Mississippi

   Metal components(1)      132,752         Owned   

Omaha, Nebraska

   Metal components(5)      55,460         Owned   

Rome, New York

   Metal components(5)      83,500         Owned   

Caryville, Tennessee

   Engineered building systems(4)      218,430         Owned   

Elizabethton, Tennessee

   Engineered building systems(4)      227,341         Owned   

Lexington, Tennessee

   Engineered building systems(6)      140,504         Owned   

Memphis, Tennessee

   Metal coil coating      65,895         Owned   

Ennis, Texas

   Metal components(1)      68,627         Owned   

Houston, Texas

   Metal components(3)      335,756         Owned   

Houston, Texas

   Metal coil coating      36,509         Owned   

Houston, Texas

   Engineered building systems(4)(7)      615,064         Owned   

Houston, Texas

   Doors and related metal components      42,500         Owned   

Lubbock, Texas

   Metal components(1)      95,361         Owned   

San Antonio, Texas

   Metal components(5)      42,400         Owned   

Salt Lake City, Utah

   Metal components(3)      93,508         Owned   

Spokane, Washington

   Engineered building systems(4)      159,000         Owned   

Foreign:

        

Monterrey, Mexico

   Engineered building systems(6)      256,553         Owned   

 

(1) Secondary structures and metal roof and wall systems.

 

32


Table of Contents
(2) End walls, secondary structures and metal roof and wall systems for components and engineered building systems.
(3) Full components product range.
(4) Primary structures, secondary structures and metal roof and wall systems for engineered building systems.
(5) Metal roof and wall systems.
(6) Primary structures for engineered building systems.
(7) Structural steel.
(8) Insulated panel systems.

We also operate six Metal Depots facilities in our metal components segment that sell our products directly to the public. We also maintain several drafting office facilities in various states. We have short-term leases for these additional facilities. We believe that our present facilities are adequate for our current and projected operations.

Additionally, we own approximately seven acres of land in Houston, Texas and have a 60,000 square foot facility that is used as our principal executive and administrative offices. We also own approximately five acres of land at another location in Houston adjacent to one of our manufacturing facilities. We own approximately 15 acres of undeveloped land adjacent to our Garco facility in Spokane, Washington.

As a result of the market downturn in 2008 and 2009, we implemented a three-phase process to resize and realign our manufacturing operations. The purpose of these activities was to close some of our least efficient facilities and to retool certain facilities to allow us to better utilize our assets and expand into new markets or better provide products to our customers, such as insulated panel systems. We are currently retooling two additional manufacturing facilities for insulated panel system products. These facilities will become operational during 2012. As a result of the implementation of this three-phase restructuring plan, we are realizing significant fixed cost savings compared to fiscal year 2008. We have incurred facility closure costs of $20.3 million through October 31, 2010 related to the three-phase restructuring plan and do not expect to incur additional significant costs under the plan.

In June 2010, we completed the purchase of an idle coating facility located in Middletown, Ohio. The facility includes a 170,000 square foot coil coating plant situated on approximately 21 acres of land. The facility will remain idle until fiscal 2013, at the earliest.

Item 3. Legal Proceedings.

We were engaged in a lawsuit that was originally filed by us on August 8, 2008 in state district court in Houston, Texas, with one of our direct customers and 14 of its end-user customers regarding alleged leaks from our roofing panels. We sought to recover approximately $0.4 million owed for materials that were delivered to our direct customer as well as attorneys’ fees and expenses in the lawsuit. In response to the lawsuit, our direct customer asserted various counterclaims and that it was entitled to actual damages in the amount of approximately $3.2 million plus attorneys’ fees and punitive damages. During fiscal 2010 and into the first quarter of fiscal 2011, the end-users of our roofing panels intervened in the lawsuit and asserted various claims against us and that they were collectively entitled to actual damages in the amount of approximately $12 million plus attorneys’ fees and punitive damages.

Trial began on July 5, 2011 and concluded on July 21, 2011. On July 22, 2011, a jury returned a verdict on all counts in favor of the Company. Additionally, the jury found in favor of the Company on our direct customer’s claims for breach of contract, breach of implied warranties, fraud, violations of the Texas Deceptive Trade Practices Act, tortious interference, business disparagement, strict products liability, and negligent design, manufacture and marketing. Further, the jury found in favor of the Company on the end-users’ claims for breach of implied warranties, violations of the Texas Deceptive Trade Practices Act, strict products liability and negligent design, manufacturing and marketing. On August 26, 2011, the district court judge entered final

 

33


Table of Contents

judgment against our direct customer awarding the Company approximately (i) $0.4 million owed for materials that were delivered but not paid by our direct customer, (ii) approximately $0.3 million in attorneys’ fees, (iii) approximately $0.2 million in prejudgment interest, and (iv) up to $0.125 million in the event this lawsuit is appealed. A notice of appeal was filed by our direct customer on October 12, 2011.

As a manufacturer of products primarily for use in nonresidential building construction, we are inherently exposed to various types of contingent claims, both asserted and unasserted, in the ordinary course of business. As a result, from time to time, we and/or our subsidiaries become involved in various legal proceedings or other contingent matters arising from claims, or potential claims. We insure against these risks to the extent deemed prudent by our management and to the extent insurance is available. Many of these insurance policies contain deductibles or self-insured retentions in amounts we deem prudent and for which we are responsible for payment. In determining the amount of self-insurance, it is our policy to self-insure those losses that are predictable, measurable and recurring in nature, such as claims for automobile liability, general liability and workers compensation. The Company regularly reviews the status of on-going proceedings and other contingent matters along with legal counsel. Liabilities for such items are recorded when it is probable that the liability has been incurred and when the amount of the liability can be reasonably estimated. Liabilities are adjusted when additional information becomes available. Management believes that the ultimate disposition of these matters will not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s operations or financial position taken as a whole.

 

34


Table of Contents

PART II

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities.

PRICE RANGE OF COMMON STOCK

Our common stock is listed on the NYSE under the symbol “NCS.” As of December 16, 2011, there were 58 holders of record and an estimated 9,000 beneficial owners of our common stock. The following table sets forth the quarterly high and low sale prices of our common stock, as reported by the NYSE, for the prior two fiscal years. We have never paid dividends on our common stock and the terms of our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility either limit or restrict our ability to do so. As a result of certain restrictions on dividend payments in our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility, the dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock for each quarter of fiscal 2010 and 2011, with the exception of the December 15, 2010 and March 15, 2011 payments, were paid in-kind. The September 15, 2011 dividend payment was paid in-kind at a pro rata rate of 8% per annum while the remaining fiscal 2010 and 2011 dividend payments that were paid-in-kind were paid at a pro rata rate of 12% per annum. On December 15, 2010 and March 15, 2011, we paid the $5.55 million and $5.5 million, respectively, Convertible Preferred Stock dividend in cash at a pro rata rate of 8% per annum. The determination of cash payment versus payment in-kind or “PIK” of the Convertible Preferred Stock dividends is made each quarter adhering to the limitations of our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility as well as the Company’s intermediate and long term cash flow requirements. Our Amended Credit Agreement currently restricts the payment of cash dividends to 50% of cumulative earnings beginning with the fourth quarter of 2009, and in the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan of which we used $11.0 million as of October 30, 2011. For additional information regarding the restrictions on the payment of dividends contained in our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility, see “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources.”

 

Fiscal Year 2011

Quarter Ended

   High      Low  

January 30

   $ 14.24       $ 9.60   

May 1

   $ 15.15       $ 11.19   

July 31

   $ 12.71       $ 9.79   

October 30

   $ 11.52       $ 6.80   

Fiscal Year 2010

Quarter Ended

   High      Low  

January 31

   $ 12.20       $ 8.50   

May 2

   $ 15.95       $ 9.05   

August 1

   $ 14.02       $ 8.09   

October 31

   $ 10.80       $ 8.63   

The following table shows our purchases of our common stock during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011:

ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

 

Period

   (a) Total Number
of Shares
Purchased(1)
     (b) Average Price
Paid per Share
(or Unit)
     (c) Total Number
of Shares
Purchased as Part
of Publicly
Announced Plans
or Programs
     (d) Maximum
Number (or
Approximate
Dollar Value)  of
Shares that May
Yet be Purchased
Under the Plans or
Programs(1)
 

August 1, 2011 to August 28, 2011

     —           —           —           129,218   

August 29, 2011 to September 25, 2011

     —           —           —           129,218   

September 26, 2011 to October 30, 2011

     —           —           —           129,218   

Total

     —           —           —           129,218   

 

35


Table of Contents

 

(1) Our board of directors has authorized a stock repurchase program. Subject to applicable federal securities law, such purchases occur at times and in amounts that we deem appropriate. Shares repurchased are used primarily for later re-issuance in connection with our equity incentive and 401(k) profit sharing plans. On February 28, 2007, we publicly announced that our board of directors authorized the repurchase of an additional 1.0 million shares of our common stock. There is no time limit on the duration of the program. Although we did not repurchase any shares of our common stock during fiscal 2011, we did withhold shares of restricted stock to satisfy tax withholding obligations arising in connection with the vesting of awards of restricted stock. At October 30, 2011, there were 0.1 million shares remaining authorized for repurchase under the program.

 

36


Table of Contents

STOCK PERFORMANCE CHART

The following chart compares the yearly percentage change in the cumulative stockholder return on our common stock from October 30, 2006 to the end of the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011 with the cumulative total return on the (i) S&P SmallCap Index and (ii) S&P 600 Building Products peer group. The comparison assumes $100 was invested on October 30, 2006 in our common stock and in each of the foregoing indices and assumes reinvestment of dividends.

LOGO

In accordance with the rules and regulations of the SEC, the above stock performance chart shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material” or to be “filed” with the SEC or subject to Regulations 14A or 14C of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”) or to the liabilities of Section 18 of the Exchange Act and shall not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933 or the Exchange Act, except to the extent we specifically incorporate it by reference into such filing.

 

37


Table of Contents

Item 6. Selected Financial Data.

The selected financial data for each of the three fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009 has been derived from the Audited Consolidated Financial Statements included elsewhere herein. The selected financial data for each of the two fiscal years ended November 2, 2008 and October 28, 2007 have been derived from audited Consolidated Financial Statements not included herein. The following data should be read in conjunction with “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and the audited Consolidated Financial Statements and the notes thereto included under “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

 

     2011     2010     2009     2008(7)     2007  
     In thousands, except per share data  

Sales

   $ 959,577      $ 870,526      $ 965,252      $ 1,762,740      $ 1,625,068   

Net income (loss)

     (9,950 )(1)      (26,877 )(2)      (750,796 )(3)      73,278 (4)      58,568   

Net loss applicable to common shares

     (47,466 )(1)      (311,227 )(2)      (762,509 )(3)      73,278        58,568   

Earnings (loss) per common share(6):

          

Basic

     (2.58     (17.07     (171.18     18.58        14.67   

Diluted

     (2.58 )(1)      (17.07 )(2)      (171.18 )(3)      18.49 (4)      13.89   

Cash flow from operating activities

     41,437        6,306        95,336        40,194        137,625   

Total assets

     561,154        560,524        614,168        1,379,492        1,342,172   

Total debt

     130,699        136,305        150,249        465,244        479,374   

Convertible Preferred Stock

     273,950        256,870        222,815        —          —     

Stockholders’ equity (deficit)

   $ (35,690   $ (2,714   $ 50,078      $ 628,074      $ 549,544   

Diluted average common shares

     18,369 (5)      18,229 (5)      4,403 (5)      3,886        4,139   
(1) Includes restructuring charges of $0.3 million ($0.2 million after tax) and asset impairments of $1.1 million ($0.7 million after tax) in fiscal 2011.
(2) Includes restructuring charges of $3.5 million ($2.2 million after tax), asset impairments of $1.1 million ($0.7 million after tax) and environmental and other contingency adjustments of $0.2 million ($0.2 million after tax) in fiscal 2010.
(3) Includes goodwill and other intangible asset impairment of $622.6 million ($600.0 million after tax), debt extinguishment and refinancing costs of $97.6 million ($92.4 million after tax), lower of cost or market charge of $40.0 million ($25.8 million after tax), change in control charges of $11.2 million ($6.9 million after tax), restructuring charges of $9.1 million ($5.6 million after tax), asset impairments of $6.3 million ($3.9 million after tax), interest rate swap of $3.1 million ($1.9 million after tax) and environmental and other contingencies of $1.1 million ($0.7 million after tax) in fiscal 2009.
(4) Includes executive retirement costs of $2.9 million ($1.8 million after tax), lower of cost or market charge of $2.7 million ($1.6 million after tax), restructuring charges of $1.1 million ($0.7 million after tax) and asset impairments of $0.2 million ($0.12 million after tax) in fiscal 2008.
(5) In October 2009, we consummated an exchange offer to acquire all our 2.125% Convertible Senior Subordinated Notes due 2024 in an exchange for cash and 14.0 million shares of our common stock.
(6) Adjusted to reflect the 1-for-5 Reverse Stock Split effected on March 5, 2010.
(7) Fiscal 2008 includes 53 weeks of operating activity.

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.

OVERVIEW

We are one of North America’s largest integrated manufacturers and marketers of metal products for the nonresidential construction industry. We provide metal coil coating services and design, engineer, manufacture and market metal components and engineered building systems primarily for nonresidential construction use. We manufacture and distribute extensive lines of metal products for the nonresidential construction market under multiple brand names through a nationwide network of plants and distribution centers. We sell our products for both new construction and repair and retrofit applications.

 

38


Table of Contents

Metal components offer builders, designers, architects and end-users several advantages, including lower long-term costs, longer life, attractive aesthetics and design flexibility. Similarly, engineered building systems offer a number of advantages over traditional construction alternatives, including shorter construction time, more efficient use of materials, lower construction costs, greater ease of expansion and lower maintenance costs.

We use a 52/53 week year with our fiscal year end on the Sunday closest to October 31.

We assess performance across our business segments by analyzing and evaluating (i) gross profit, operating income, and whether or not each segment has achieved its projected sales goals, (ii) non-financial efficiency indicators such as gross profit per employee, man hours per ton of steel produced and shipped tons per day. In assessing our overall financial performance, we regard return on adjusted operating assets, as well as growth in earnings, as key indicators of shareholder value.

Fiscal 2011 Overview

Despite continued declines in nonresidential construction activity, our financial results improved in fiscal 2011 compared to fiscal 2010. Nonresidential new construction starts, as measured in square feet, decreased 5% in fiscal 2011. Overcoming a 4% reduction in tons shipped, our engineered building systems segment’s gross profit increased 410 basis points in fiscal 2011 compared to fiscal 2010. We believe this demonstrates tangible, measureable improvements that our initiatives are producing despite market challenges. In addition, we are encouraged by the 38.7% increase in bookings that our engineered building systems segment has experienced in the second half of fiscal 2011 compared to the same period in fiscal 2010, and an increase of 24.4% over the same period in 2009. This is in part the result of higher demand from the manufacturing and energy markets. Our revenues from these markets increased approximately 11% in fiscal 2011 over the prior fiscal year. We believe the industrial sector will continue to lead the recovery in the U.S. economy, and we expect the manufacturing and energy sectors to continue to improve even through a choppy economic recovery.

Our metal components segment though still quite profitable did not perform as well in fiscal 2011 compared to fiscal 2010. While the insulated metal panels, roll up doors and products for the agriculture sector experienced growth in fiscal 2011 compared to fiscal 2010, the segment’s core commercial and industrial business remained slow, in line with broader nonresidential market conditions. The metal components segment does not have the benefit of backlog because orders typically entail rapid delivery. Accordingly, we do not have the visibility that we have in our engineered building systems segment, however we expect, consistent with historical correlations, that the metal components segment will experience improvement as a result of the increased bookings in the engineered building systems segment.

The metal coil coating segment continued to increase third party sales, which increased 16% in fiscal 2011 compared to fiscal 2010, and led to an 11% increase in operating income for the fiscal year. This segment supports all of our internal requirements for coated and painted steel with a focus on safety and quality.

We believe that each segment of our business is well positioned to capitalize on the eventual recovery in nonresidential construction activity and we are continuing to pursue strategies to enhance our position regardless of the pace of the recovery.

Industry Conditions

Our sales and earnings are subject to both seasonal and cyclical trends and are influenced by general economic conditions, interest rates, the price of steel relative to other building materials, the level of nonresidential construction activity, roof repair and retrofit demand and the availability and cost of financing for construction projects.

 

39


Table of Contents

The nonresidential construction industry is highly sensitive to national and regional macroeconomic conditions. One of the primary challenges we face is that the United States economy is slowly recovering from a recession and is in a period of significant volatility which, beginning in the third quarter of 2008, has reduced demand for our products and adversely affected our business. In addition, the tightening of credit in financial markets over the same period has adversely affected the ability of our customers to obtain financing for construction projects. As a result, we have experienced decreases in and cancellations of orders for our products in previous fiscal quarters, and the ability of our customers to make payments has been adversely affected. Similar factors could cause our suppliers to experience financial distress or bankruptcy, resulting in temporary raw material shortages. The lack of credit also adversely affects nonresidential construction, which is the focus of our business. While economic growth has either resumed or remains flat, the nonresidential construction industry continues to face significant challenges. The graph below shows the annual nonresidential new construction starts, measured in square feet, since 1968 as compiled and reported by McGraw-Hill:

LOGO

Source: McGraw-Hill

When assessing the state of the metal construction market, we review information from various industry associations, third-party research, and various government reports such as industrial production and capacity utilization. One such industry association is the Metal Building Manufacturers Association (“MBMA”), which provides summary member sales information and promotes the design and construction of metal buildings and metal roofing systems. Another is McGraw-Hill Construction Information Group, which we review for information regarding actual and forecasted growth in various construction related industries, including the overall nonresidential construction market. McGraw-Hill Construction’s nonresidential construction forecast for calendar 2011, updated in October 2011, indicates an expected reduction of 4% in square footage and a decrease of 6% in dollar value as compared to the prior calendar year. In calendar 2012, activity is expected to increase compared to calendar 2011, with an expected increase of 2% in square footage and an increase of 2% in dollar value. Additionally, we review the American Institute of Architects’ (“AIA”) survey for inquiry and billing activity for the industrial, commercial and institutional sectors. AIA’s architectural billing index (“ABI”) is a closely watched metric, as billing growth for architectural services generally leads to construction spending growth 9 to 12 months forward. An ABI reading above 50 indicates an increase in month-to-month billings and a

 

40


Table of Contents

reading below 50 indicates a decrease in month-to-month billings. AIA’s ABI published for October 2011 was below 50 at 49.4 but the commercial and industrial component of the index was at 53.5 for October 2011, the second consecutive month above 50.

Another challenge we face both short and long term is the volatility in the price of steel. Our business is heavily dependent on the supply of steel and is significantly impacted by steel prices. For the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011, steel represented approximately 72% of our costs of goods sold. The steel industry is highly cyclical in nature, and steel prices have been volatile in recent years and may remain volatile in the future. Steel prices are influenced by numerous factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions domestically and internationally, competition, labor costs, production costs, import duties and other trade restrictions.

The monthly CRU North American Steel Price Index, published by the CRU Group, has increased 16.8% from October 2010 to October 2011 and was 2.6% higher in October 2010 compared to October 2009. The unusual level of volatility in 2009 negatively impacted our business. In the first two quarters of fiscal 2009, we recorded a $40.0 million charge to cost of sales to adjust certain raw material inventory to the lower of cost or market because this inventory exceeded our estimates of net realizable value less normal profit margins. Our sales volume in 2009 was significantly lower than previously anticipated. Some customers delayed projects in an effort to wait and see how low steel prices would fall. For additional discussion of steel prices, see “Item 3. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.”

We do not have any long-term contracts for the purchase of steel and normally do not maintain an inventory of steel in excess of our current production requirements. However, from time to time, we may purchase steel in advance of announced steel price increases. We can give no assurance that steel will be readily available or that prices will not continue to be volatile. While most of our sales contracts have escalation clauses that allow us, under certain circumstances, to pass along all or a portion of increases in the price of steel after the date of the contract but prior to delivery, for competitive or other reasons we may not be able to pass such price increases along. If the available supply of steel declines, we could experience price increases that we are not able to pass on to the end users, a deterioration of service from our suppliers or interruptions or delays that may cause us not to meet delivery schedules to our customers. Any of these problems could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. For additional discussion please see “Item 1. Business — Raw Materials,” “Item 1A. Risk Factors — We rely on a few major suppliers for our supply of steel, which makes us more vulnerable to supply constraints and pricing pressure, as well as the financial condition of those suppliers,” “— Liquidity and Capital Resources — Steel Prices” and “Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk — Steel Prices.”

As a result of the market downturn in 2008 and 2009, we implemented a three-phase process to resize and realign our manufacturing operations. The purpose of these activities was to close some of our least efficient facilities and to retool certain facilities to allow us to better utilize our assets and expand into new markets or better provide products to our customers, such as insulated panel systems. As a result of the implementation of this three-phase restructuring plan, we are realizing significant fixed cost savings compared to fiscal year 2008. We have incurred facility closure costs of $20.3 million from October 29, 2007 through October 31, 2010 related to the three-phase restructuring plan and have not incurred significant additional costs beyond fiscal 2010 under the plan.

2009 Recapitalization Plan and Refinancing Transaction

On October 20, 2009, we issued and sold to the CD&R Funds an aggregate of 250,000 Preferred Shares for an aggregate purchase price of $250.0 million. The Preferred Shares are convertible into shares of our Common Stock, and, as of October 30, 2011, the Preferred Shares represented 70.1% of our voting power and Common Stock on an as-converted basis.

As of October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009, the Preferred Shares were convertible into 46.6 million, 44.3 million and 39.2 million shares of Common Stock, respectively, at an initial conversion price of $6.3740 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split). However, as of November 1, 2009, only

 

41


Table of Contents

approximately 1.8 million shares of Common Stock were authorized and unissued, and therefore the CD&R Funds were not able to fully convert the Preferred Shares. To the extent the CD&R Funds opted to convert their Preferred Shares, as of November 1, 2009, their conversion right was limited to conversion of that portion of their Preferred Shares into the approximately 1.8 million shares of Common Stock that were currently authorized and unissued. Following shareholder approval and by action of the independent, non-CD&R board members, on March 5, 2010, we effected the Reverse Stock Split at an exchange ratio of 1-for-5. As of that date, the Preferred Shares accrued for and held by the CD&R Funds were fully convertible into 41.0 million Common Shares. As a result, we recorded an additional beneficial conversion feature charge in the amount of $230.9 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2010 related to the availability of shares of Common Stock into which the CD&R Funds may convert their Preferred Shares. In addition, we recorded an additional $19.4 million beneficial conversion feature charge in fiscal 2010 related to dividends that have accrued and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. In fiscal 2011, we recorded a net $9.4 million beneficial conversion feature charge related to dividends that have accrued and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. We expect to recognize additional beneficial conversion feature charges in the future as paid-in-kind dividends are accrued on the Preferred Shares to the extent the market price of our Common Stock exceeds $6.37. Our policy is to recognize beneficial conversion feature charges on paid-in-kind dividends based on a daily dividend recognition and the daily closing stock price of our Common Stock.

Dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock are payable, on a cumulative daily basis, as and if declared by our board of directors, at a rate per annum of 12% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus accrued and unpaid dividends thereon or at a rate per annum of 8% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon if paid in cash on the dividend payment date on which such dividends would otherwise compound. If dividends are not paid on the dividend payment date, either in cash or in-kind, such dividends compound on the dividend payment date. Members of the board of directors who are not affiliated with the CD&R Funds have the right to choose whether such dividends are paid in cash or in-kind, subject to the conditions of the Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility. Our Amended Credit Agreement currently restricts the payment of cash dividends to 50% of cumulative earnings beginning with the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, and in the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan of which we used $11.0 million as of October 30, 2011. Each quarterly dividend payment cannot be split between cash and payment-in-kind. Our ABL Facility, among other potentially available baskets, permits us to pay cash dividends, including on the Convertible Preferred Stock, up to $6.5 million each calendar quarter, provided (i) certain excess availability conditions or (ii) certain other excess availability conditions and a fixed charge coverage ratio under the ABL Facility are satisfied.

At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had Preferred Shares outstanding of 286,701 and 272,503, respectively. In addition, at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had accrued but unpaid cash dividends and Preferred Stock dividends with a value of $10.1 million and $10.0 million, respectively. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the outstanding Preferred Shares, including accrued but unpaid dividends, were convertible into 46.6 million and 44.3 million shares of common stock. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the aggregate liquidation preference plus aggregate accrued dividends of the Convertible Preferred Stock was $296.8 million and $282.5 million, respectively.

Simultaneously with the closing of the Equity Investment, we took the following actions (together with the Equity Investment, the “Recapitalization Plan”):

 

   

we entered into the Amended Credit Agreement, pursuant to which we repaid $143.3 million of the $293.3 million in principal amount of term loans outstanding under such credit agreement and modified the terms and maturity of the remaining $150 million balance. The terms of the term loan require quarterly principal payments in an amount equal to 0.25% of the principal amount of the term loan then outstanding as of the last day of each calendar quarter and a final payment of approximately $136.3 million at maturity on April 20, 2014. We made a mandatory prepayment on the Amended

 

42


Table of Contents
 

Credit Agreement in May 2010 in connection with our tax refund resulting from the carry back of the 2009 net operating loss. In fiscal 2011, we made optional prepayments in the amounts of $5.6 million. These prepayments are allowed to be applied against the remaining quarterly principal payments and, as a result, we are not required to make any additional quarterly principal payments for the remainder of the term loan.

 

   

we entered into the ABL Facility pursuant to a loan and security agreement that provided for a $125.0 million asset-based loan facility. The ABL Facility allows us an aggregate maximum borrowing of up to $125 million; however, the aggregate maximum borrowings are limited to $100.0 million under our Amended Credit Agreement. The ABL Facility has an additional $50 million incremental credit facility. The ABL Facility has a maturity of April 20, 2014 and includes borrowing capacity of up to $25 million for letters of credit and up to $10 million for swingline borrowings. On December 3, 2010, we finalized an amendment of our ABL Facility that reduces the unused commitment fee from 1% or 0.75% based on the average daily balance of loans and letters of credit obligations outstanding to an annual rate of 0.5%, reduces the effective interest rate on borrowings, if any, by nearly 40% or 175 basis points and relaxes the prohibitions against paying cash dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock to allow, in the aggregate, up to $6.5 million of cash dividends or other payments each calendar quarter, provided (i) certain excess availability conditions or (ii) certain other excess availability conditions and a fixed charge coverage ratio under the ABL Facility are satisfied.

 

   

we completed the Exchange Offer to acquire the $180 million of our then-outstanding Convertible Notes for an aggregate combination of $90.0 million in cash and 14.0 million shares of Common Stock.

The refinancing of our term loan and our entry into the revolving credit facility are further described under “–– Liquidity and Capital Resources –– Debt — Amended Credit Agreement” and “–– Liquidity and Capital Resources –– Debt — ABL Facility” below.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following table presents, as a percentage of sales, certain selected consolidated financial data for the periods indicated:

 

     Fiscal year ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 

Sales

     100.0     100.0     100.0

Cost of sales

     79.0        80.4        77.6   

Lower of cost or market adjustment

     —          —          4.1   

Asset impairments, net

     0.1        0.1        0.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     20.9        19.5        17.6   

Engineering, selling, general and administrative expenses

     21.1        21.9        21.8   

Goodwill and other intangible asset impairments

     —          —          64.5   

Restructuring charges (recovery)

     (0.0     0.4        0.9   

Change in control charges

     —          —          1.2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (0.2     (2.8     (70.8

Interest income

     0.0        0.0        0.0   

Interest expense

     (1.6     (2.0     (3.0

Debt extinguishment and refinancing costs

     —          (0.0     (10.1

Other income, net

     0.1        0.2        0.2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (1.7     (4.6     (83.7

Benefit from income taxes

     (0.7     (1.5     (5.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

     (1.0 )%      (3.1 )%      (77.8 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

43


Table of Contents

SUPPLEMENTARY BUSINESS SEGMENT INFORMATION

We have aggregated our operations into three reportable segments based upon similarities in product lines, manufacturing processes, marketing and management of our businesses: metal coil coating; metal components; and engineered building systems. All business segments operate primarily in the nonresidential construction market. Sales and earnings are influenced by general economic conditions, the level of nonresidential construction activity, metal roof repair and retrofit demand and the availability and terms of financing available for construction. Products of all our business segments use similar basic raw materials. The metal coil coating segment consists of cleaning, treating, painting and slitting continuous steel coils before the steel is fabricated for use by construction and industrial users. The metal components segment products include metal roof and wall panels, doors, metal partitions, metal trim, insulated panels and other related accessories. The engineered building systems segment includes the manufacturing of main frames, Long Bay® Systems and value-added engineering and drafting, which are typically not part of metal components or metal coil coating products or services. The reporting segments follow the same accounting policies used for our Consolidated Financial Statements.

We evaluate a segment’s performance based primarily upon operating income before corporate expenses. Intersegment sales are recorded based on standard material costs plus a standard markup to cover labor and overhead and consist of: (i) hot-rolled, light gauge painted, and slit material and other services provided by the metal coil coating segment to both the metal components and engineered building systems segments; (ii) building components provided by the metal components segment to the engineered building systems segment; and (iii) structural framing provided by the engineered building systems segment to the metal components segment.

Corporate assets consist primarily of cash but also include deferred financing costs, deferred taxes and property, plant and equipment associated with our headquarters in Houston, Texas. These items (and income and expenses related to these items) are not allocated to the business segments. Corporate unallocated expenses include executive, legal, finance, tax, treasury, human resources, information technology, purchasing, marketing and corporate travel expenses. Additional unallocated expenses include interest income, interest expense, debt extinguishment and refinancing costs and other (expense) income. Segment information is included in Note 23 of our Consolidated Financial Statements.

The following table represents total sales, external sales and operating income attributable to these business segments for the periods indicated (in thousands, except percentages):

 

     2011     %     2010     %     2009     %  

Total sales:

            

Metal coil coating

   $ 201,098        21      $ 181,874        21      $ 169,897        18   

Metal components

     437,655        46        415,857        48        458,734        47   

Engineered building systems

     548,594        57        490,746        56        538,938        56   

Intersegment sales

     (227,770     (24     (217,951     (25     (202,317     (21
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net sales

   $ 959,577        100      $ 870,526        100      $ 965,252        100   

External sales:

            

Metal coil coating

   $ 75,394        8      $ 65,240        7      $ 53,189        6   

Metal components

     353,797        37        328,077        38        389,132        40   

Engineered building systems

     530,386        55        477,209        55        522,931        54   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net sales

   $ 959,577        100      $ 870,526        100      $ 965,252        100   

Operating income (loss):

            

Metal coil coating

   $ 17,944        $ 16,166        $ (99,689  

Metal components

     20,643          26,791          (130,039  

Engineered building systems

     13,011          (18,438       (389,007  

Corporate

     (53,225       (49,106       (64,583  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total operating income (loss)

   $ (1,627     $ (24,587     $ (683,318  

Unallocated other expense

     (14,720       (15,620       (124,391  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Loss before income taxes

   $ (16,347     $ (40,207     $ (807,709  

 

44


Table of Contents

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS FOR FISCAL 2011 COMPARED TO FISCAL 2010

Consolidated sales increased by 10.2%, or $89.1 million for fiscal 2011, compared to fiscal 2010. This increase resulted from higher relative sales prices in each of our segments, which mainly increased as a result of the pass-through of higher underlying steel costs. This increase was partially offset by lower tonnage volumes in our metal components and engineered building systems segments in fiscal 2011 compared to fiscal 2010 which was the result of softer overall market demand, reflecting the decline in nonresidential construction activity compared to the prior year’s period. This continued general weakness of nonresidential construction activity is affirmed by the 5.9% decrease in low-rise nonresidential (up to 5 stories) square-footage starts, as reported by McGraw-Hill, for fiscal 2011 compared to the same period in the prior year.

Consolidated cost of sales increased by 8.3%, or $58.4 million for fiscal 2011, compared to fiscal 2010. Gross margins were 20.9% for fiscal 2011 compared to 19.5% for the same period in the prior year. The increase in gross margins was the result of higher relative sales prices in each of our segments, partially offset by decreased volumes in our metal components and engineered building systems segments.

Metal coil coating sales increased by 10.6%, or $19.2 million to $201.1 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $181.9 million in the same period in the prior year. Sales to third parties for fiscal 2011 increased by 15.6% to $75.4 million from $65.2 million in the same period in the prior year, primarily as a result of a 19.1% increase in sales prices, which mainly increased as a result of the pass-through of higher underlying steel costs and a 6.0% increase in external volume. This increase was partially offset by a shift in product mix from package sales of coated steel products to tolling revenue for coating services. Package sales include both the toll processing services and the sale of the steel coil while toll processing services include only the toll processing service performed on the steel coil already in the customer’s ownership. The remaining $9.1 million represents an increase in intersegment sales for fiscal 2011 compared to the same period in the prior year. Metal coil coating third-party sales accounted for 7.9% of total consolidated third-party sales in fiscal 2011 compared to 7.5% in fiscal 2010.

Operating income of the metal coil coating segment increased to $17.9 million in fiscal 2011 compared to $16.2 million in the same period in the prior year, primarily due to a $2.1 million increase in gross profit resulting mainly from higher relative sales prices.

Metal components sales increased 5.2%, or $21.8 million to $437.7 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $415.9 million in the same period in the prior year. This increase compared to the same period in the prior year was primarily due to higher sales prices, which mainly increased as a result of the pass-through of higher underlying steel costs, partially offset by a 1.1% decrease in external tons shipped. Sales to third parties for fiscal 2011 increased $25.7 million to $353.8 million from $328.1 million in the same period in the prior year. The remaining $3.9 million represents a decrease in intersegment sales. These results were primarily driven by softer overall market demand resulting from the general weakness of nonresidential construction activity in fiscal 2011. Metal components third-party sales accounted for 36.9% of total consolidated third-party sales in fiscal 2011 compared to 37.7% in fiscal 2010.

Operating income of the metal components segment decreased to $20.6 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $26.8 million in the same period in the prior year. The $6.1 million decrease resulted from a $2.5 million decrease in gross profit due to a decrease in external tons shipped noted above and a $1.9 million increase in selling and administrative expenses related to a $2.4 million increase in an actuarial determined general liability self-insurance reserve and a $1.1 million increase in bad debt expense, partially offset by a $0.5 million in restructuring charges in the same period in the prior year.

Engineered building systems sales increased 11.8%, or $57.8 million to $548.6 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $490.7 million in the same period in prior year. This increase resulted from higher sales prices which mainly increased as a result of the pass-through of higher underlying steel costs, partially offset by a 4.4% decrease in

 

45


Table of Contents

external tons shipped. Sales to third parties for fiscal 2011 increased $53.2 million to $530.4 million from $477.2 million in the same period in the prior year. The remaining $4.7 million represents an increase in intersegment sales. These results were primarily driven by softer overall market demand, which resulted from the general weakness of nonresidential construction activity in fiscal 2011. Engineered building systems third-party sales accounted for 55.3% of total consolidated third-party sales in fiscal 2011 compared to 54.8% in fiscal 2010.

Operating income (loss) of the engineered building systems segment improved to income of $13.0 million in fiscal 2011 compared to a loss of $18.4 million in the same period in the prior year. This $31.4 million improvement resulted from a $31.6 million increase in gross profit, $3.3 million of restructuring charges (recovery) primarily related to $3.0 million of restructuring charges in the same period in the prior year. The increase in gross profit was due to increases in relative sales prices noted above. These improvements were partially offset by a $3.2 million increase in engineering, selling and administrative expenses primarily due to a $4.6 million increase in wages, commissions and benefit costs, a $0.9 million increase in marketing costs and a $0.6 million increase in travel and entertainment costs, partially offset by a $3.3 million decrease in legal contingencies and costs and a $0.6 million decrease in general liability costs.

Consolidated engineering, selling, general and administrative expenses, consisting of engineering, drafting, selling and administrative costs, increased to $202.4 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $190.9 million in the same period in the prior year. The increase of $11.5 million in engineering, selling and administrative expenses was primarily due to a $5.7 million increase in wages, commissions and benefit costs, a $2.4 million increase in an actuarial determined general liability self-insurance reserve, a $2.0 million increase in stock based compensation expense, a $1.7 million increase in bad debt expense and a $0.9 million increase in marketing costs, partially offset by a $2.2 million decrease in legal contingencies and costs and a $1.3 million decrease in other general liability costs. As a percentage of sales, engineering, selling, general and administrative expenses were 21.1% for fiscal 2011 as compared to 21.9% for fiscal 2010.

Consolidated restructuring charges (recovery) improved to a benefit of $0.3 million for fiscal 2011, compared to an expense of $3.5 million for the same period of the prior year. This decrease of $3.8 million was primarily related to $3.5 million of idle facility costs in connection with the closing of certain facilities in the engineered building systems and metal components segments in the same period in the prior year and a $0.6 million recovery in the current period as a result of a legal settlement for a closed facility. The purpose of these activities was to close some of our least efficient facilities and to retool certain of these facilities to allow us to better utilize our assets and expand into new markets or better provide products to our customers.

Consolidated interest expense decreased by 12.3% to $15.7 million for fiscal 2011, compared to $17.9 million for the same period of the prior year. Interest expense decreased due to decreases in the underlying debt balances, a reduction in the unused commitment fee and letter of credit fees which was finalized in an amendment to our ABL Facility in December 2010 and amortization of capitalized interest on projects.

Other income, net decreased by 58.9% to $0.9 million for fiscal 2011, compared to $2.1 million for the same period in the prior year. This decrease was primarily the result of a $1.0 million decrease in foreign currency losses, a $0.9 million decrease in the fair value of the embedded derivative from the same period in the prior year, partially offset by $0.8 million of various other gains.

Consolidated benefit from income taxes decreased to $6.4 million for fiscal 2011, compared to $13.3 million for the same period in the prior year. The effective tax rate benefit for fiscal 2011 was 39.1% compared to 33.2% for the same period in the prior year.

Consolidated Convertible Preferred Stock dividends and accretion for fiscal 2011 was $28.1 million compared to $34.1 million in the same period in the prior year and related primarily to our paying accrued dividends on Convertible Preferred Stock. We paid $11.0 million of dividends at the rate of 8% per annum on the Preferred Shares in cash which were related to the December 15, 2010 and March 15, 2011 dividend payments. We paid the June 15,

 

46


Table of Contents

2011 and September 15, 2011 dividend payments on the Preferred Shares in-kind which were related to the period from March 16, 2011 to September 15, 2011. We paid paid-in-kind dividends at the rate of 8% per annum in September 2011 as a result of the September 6, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent.

Consolidated Convertible Preferred Stock beneficial conversion feature charge for fiscal 2011 was $9.4 million compared to $250.3 million in the same period in the prior year. The fiscal 2010 charge related to the beneficial conversion feature on the Convertible Preferred Stock because it was issued on October 20, 2009 with an initial conversion price of $6.3740 per Common Share equivalent (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split) and the closing stock price per Common Share just prior to the closing of the equity investment by Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. and CD&R Friends and Family Fund VIII, L.P. (the “CD&R Funds”) (further described in “—Liquidity and Capital Resources––Convertible Preferred Stock”) was $12.55 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split). As a result of the Reverse Stock Split on March 5, 2010, the contingencies related to the 41.0 million shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of the Preferred Shares were resolved. We recorded an additional beneficial conversion feature charge in the amount of $230.9 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2010 related to the availability of shares of Common Stock into which the CD&R Funds may convert their Preferred Shares.

We recorded beneficial conversion feature charges of $9.4 million in fiscal 2011 compared to $19.4 million in fiscal 2010, related to dividends that have accrued on the Convertible Preferred Stock and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. The decrease was the result of (1) our paying the December 2010 and March 2011 dividends in cash (at the rate of 8% per annum), rather than in-kind (at the rate of 12% per annum) and (2) our paying the September 2011 dividend in-kind at the rate of 8% per annum (rather than the stated 12%) as a result of the September 6, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent. We expect to recognize additional beneficial conversion feature charges in the future as paid-in-kind dividends are accrued on the Convertible Preferred Stock to the extent each day’s stock price is in excess of $6.3740, the conversion price applicable to the Convertible Preferred Stock.

Diluted loss per common share decreased to $(2.58) per diluted common share for fiscal 2011, compared to $(17.07) per diluted common share for the same period in the prior year. The decrease in the diluted loss per common share was primarily due to a $263.8 million decrease in net loss applicable to shares of our Common Stock resulting from the factors described above in this section. At October 30, 2011, the Preferred Shares were convertible into 46.6 million shares of Common Stock. The Convertible Preferred Stock and the unvested restricted Common Stock related to our Incentive Plan do not have a contractual obligation to share in losses; therefore, no losses were allocated to these shares in both periods presented. These participating securities will be allocated earnings when applicable.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS FOR FISCAL 2010 COMPARED TO FISCAL 2009

Consolidated sales decreased by 9.8%, or $94.7 million for fiscal 2010, compared to fiscal 2009. This decrease resulted from lower relative sales prices in our metal components and engineered building systems segments, partially offset by a slight 0.4% increase in external tonnage volumes. Higher tonnage volumes in the metal coil coating and engineered building systems segment in fiscal 2010 compared to fiscal 2009 were driven by increased market share for such products compared to the prior year notwithstanding a 24.9% decrease in low-rise nonresidential (less than 5 stories) square-footage starts, as reported by McGraw-Hill for fiscal 2010 compared to the prior year.

Consolidated cost of sales decreased by 6.6%, or $49.1 million for fiscal 2010, compared to fiscal 2009. Gross margins were 19.5% for fiscal 2010 compared to 17.6% for fiscal 2009. During fiscal 2009, we recorded a $40.0 million inventory adjustment to adjust the carrying amount on certain raw material inventory to the lower of cost or market because this inventory exceeded our current estimates of net realizable value less normal profit margins, which accounted for 4.1% of the reduction in the gross margin percentage in the prior year. In addition, asset impairment charges in fiscal 2010 compared to fiscal 2009 decreased $5.2 million primarily as a result of a $6.3 million asset impairment charge in fiscal 2009 related to plant closures in our restructuring plan which impacted both our engineered metal buildings and metal components segments. The decrease in asset impairment charges accounted for 0.5% of the improvement in gross margin percentage in fiscal 2010.

 

47


Table of Contents

Metal coil coating sales increased by 7.0%, or $12.0 million to $181.9 million in fiscal 2010, compared to $169.9 million in the prior year. Sales to third parties for fiscal 2010 increased by 22.7% to $65.2 million from $53.2 million in the prior year, primarily as a result of a 8.5% increase in external volume, a shift in product mix from tolling revenue for coating services to package sales of coated steel products and a 2.1% increase in sales prices. Generally, package sales of coated steel products contribute lower margin dollars per ton as a percentage of revenue, compared to toll processing sales. Package sales include both the toll processing services and the sale of the steel coil while toll processing services include only the toll processing service performed on the steel coil already owned by the customer. In addition, there was a $0.1 million decrease in intersegment sales for fiscal 2010 compared to the prior year. Metal coil coating third-party sales accounted for 7.5% of total consolidated third-party sales in fiscal 2010 compared to 5.5% in fiscal 2009.

Operating income (loss) of the metal coil coating segment increased to income of $16.2 million in fiscal 2010 compared to a loss of $(99.7) million in the prior year, primarily due to goodwill and other intangible asset impairments of $99.0 million in the prior year and an $8.1 million charge to adjust inventory to lower of cost or market in the same period in the prior year. In addition, there was a $8.9 million increase in gross profit in fiscal 2010 compared to fiscal 2009 primarily due to lower costs as a result of increased material utilization and improved fixed cost absorption with higher volumes.

Metal components sales decreased 9.3%, or $42.9 million to $415.9 million in fiscal 2010, compared to $458.7 million in the prior year. Sales were down compared to prior year due to a 13.8% decrease in external tons shipped and lower sales prices. Sales to third parties for fiscal 2010 decreased $61.1 million to $328.1 million from $389.1 million in the prior year. The remaining $18.2 million represents an increase in intersegment sales. These results were primarily driven by lower steel prices, reduced demand and increased competition in the market resulting from the general weakness of nonresidential construction activity in fiscal 2010. Metal components third-party sales accounted for 37.7% of total consolidated third-party sales in fiscal 2010 compared to 40.3% in fiscal 2009.

Operating income (loss) of the metal components segment increased to income of $26.8 million in fiscal 2010, compared to a loss of $(130.0) million in the prior year. This $156.8 million increase resulted from charges related to goodwill and other intangible asset impairment of $147.2 million in the same period in the prior year, a $17.2 million adjustment to inventory at the lower of cost or market in the same period in the prior year, a $0.8 million decrease in restructuring charges and $0.6 million decrease in asset impairment charges. In addition, the increase in operating income was the result of a $5.0 million decrease in selling and administrative expenses. These reductions were comprised of a $1.8 million decrease in wage, benefit and temporary labor costs resulting from the reduced workforce and cost reduction programs implemented during the prior year, a $1.5 million decrease in bad debt expense and a $1.0 million decrease in healthcare costs as a result of a reduction in claims, partially offset by a $0.6 million increase in general liability claims. These improvements were partially offset by a $14.0 million decrease in gross profit due to decreased volumes and declines in relative sales prices noted above.

Engineered building systems sales decreased 8.9%, or $48.2 million to $490.7 million in fiscal 2010, compared to $538.9 million in the prior year. This decrease resulted from lower sales prices, partially offset by a 4.4% increase in external tons shipped. Sales to third parties for fiscal 2010 decreased $45.7 million to $477.2 million from $522.9 million in the same period in the prior year. The remaining $2.5 million represents a similar decrease in intersegment sales. These results were driven by lower steel prices, reduced overall demand and increased competition in the market resulting from the general weakness of nonresidential construction activity in fiscal 2010. Engineered building systems third-party sales accounted for 54.8% of total consolidated third-party sales in fiscal 2010 compared to 54.2% in fiscal 2009.

The operating loss of the engineered building systems segment decreased to $(18.4) million in fiscal 2010 compared to $(389.0) million in the prior year. This $370.6 million improvement resulted from prior year charges related to goodwill and other intangible asset impairments of $376.4 million, a $14.7 million adjustment

 

48


Table of Contents

in inventory to the lower of cost or market, a $4.4 million decrease in restructuring charges, a $3.4 million decrease in asset impairment charges, and a $1.1 million environmental remediation charge. In addition, the decrease in operating loss was the result of a $12.8 million decrease in selling and administrative expenses that resulted from a $6.4 million decrease in wage, benefit and temporary labor costs due to a reduced workforce and cost reduction programs implemented during the prior year, a $3.7 million decrease in healthcare costs as a result of a reduction in claims, a $1.5 million decrease in professional services and a $0.9 million decrease in marketing and advertising costs, partially offset by a $1.4 million increase in other various costs. These improvements were partially offset by a $40.3 million decrease in gross profit due to declines in relative sales prices and volumes noted above.

Consolidated engineering, selling, general and administrative expenses, consisting of engineering, drafting, selling and administrative costs, decreased to $190.9 million in fiscal 2010, compared to $210.8 million in the prior year. The decrease in engineering, general and administrative expenses was primarily due to a $9.4 million decrease in wage, benefit and temporary labor costs due to a reduced workforce and cost reduction programs implemented during the prior year. The remaining decrease was the result of a $4.3 million decrease in healthcare costs as a result of a reduction in claims, a $1.9 million decrease in professional services, a $1.2 million decrease in franchise and sales tax, a $1.1 million decrease in bad debt expense and a $0.9 million decrease in marketing and advertising costs, partially offset by a $1.4 million increase in other various costs. As a percentage of sales, selling, general and administrative expenses were 21.9% for fiscal 2010 as compared to 21.8% for fiscal 2009.

Consolidated goodwill and other intangible asset impairment in fiscal 2009 was $622.6 million. No impairments were recorded in fiscal 2010. The prior year’s impairment impacted all of our reporting segments and was the result of the reduction of our future cash flow projections in the first quarter of fiscal 2009 due to the outlook of a worsening condition in the nonresidential construction industry and the result of reconciling our segment fair values to our publicly traded market capitalization.

Consolidated restructuring charges decreased to $3.5 million in fiscal 2010, compared to $9.1 million in the prior year. This decrease was primarily related to the closing of six of our engineered building systems manufacturing plants in the prior year. The purpose of these activities was to close some of our least efficient facilities in light of current demand levels and to retool certain of these facilities to allow us to better utilize our assets and expand into new markets or better provide products to our customers.

Consolidated change in control charges for fiscal 2009 in the amount of $11.2 million included $9.1 million in share-based compensation expense from the accelerated vesting of our stock incentive plans upon the change in control of our Company. We also incurred a $1.5 million charge in fiscal 2009 related to a new director and officer insurance policy upon the majority change of our board of directors. No amounts were recorded in fiscal 2010.

Consolidated interest expense decreased by 38.7% to $17.9 million for fiscal 2010, compared to $29.2 million for the prior year. In fiscal 2009, we recorded $8.4 million for the accretion of the discounted carrying value of the Convertible Notes to their face amount. In addition, we recorded a $3.1 million charge to interest expense in fiscal 2009 related to our interest rate swap contract. In connection with our 2009 refinancing, we concluded the interest rate swap agreement was no longer an effective hedge, based on the modified terms of the Amended Credit Agreement which includes a 2% LIBOR floor. As a result, in 2009 we have reclassified to interest expense the remaining deferred losses previously recorded to accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). In addition, interest expense decreased in fiscal 2010 due to a reduction of our outstanding debt as a result of our refinancing in October 2009. These decreases were partially offset by higher interest rates associated with the variable portion of our outstanding debt.

Consolidated debt extinguishment and refinancing costs were income of $0.1 million in fiscal 2010, compared to an expense of $97.6 million in the prior year. These costs related to our refinancing which was

 

49


Table of Contents

completed on October 20, 2009. The costs incurred in fiscal 2009 primarily consisted of $85.3 million related to debt extinguishment of our Convertible Notes, $6.4 million related to payments to non-creditors on the modification of our Credit Agreement and $4.8 million related to our abandoned plan for potential pre-packaged bankruptcy.

Consolidated benefit for income taxes decreased to a benefit of $(13.3) million for fiscal 2010, compared to a benefit of $(56.9) million for prior year. The decrease was primarily due to a $767.5 million decrease in pre-tax losses. The effective tax rate for fiscal 2010 was a benefit of 33.2% compared to a benefit of 7.0% in the prior year. The increase in the effective tax rate benefit was predominantly due to non-deductible goodwill impairment costs which reduced the effective tax rate by 27.0% in the prior year and the non-deductible premium on the retirement of our Convertible Notes which reduced the effective tax rate by 4.1% in prior year.

Consolidated Convertible Preferred Stock dividends and accretion increased to $34.1 million for fiscal 2010 compared to $1.2 million in the prior year and related to $31.4 million of paid and accrued dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock which accrues and accumulates dividends on a daily basis. The dividend rate accrued during such period was 12% per annum.

Consolidated Convertible Preferred Stock beneficial conversion feature increased to $250.3 million for fiscal 2010 compared to $10.5 million in the prior year and related to the beneficial conversion feature on the Convertible Preferred Stock because it was issued on October 20, 2009 with an initial conversion price $6.3740 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split) and the closing stock price per Common Share just prior to the closing of the equity investment by the CD&R Funds (further described in “— Liquidity and Capital Resources — Convertible Preferred Stock”) was $12.55 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split). As a result of the Reverse Stock Split on March 5, 2010, the contingencies related to the 41.0 million shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of the Preferred Shares were resolved. We recorded an additional beneficial conversion feature charge in the amount of $230.9 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2010 related to the availability of shares of Common Stock into which the CD&R Funds may convert their Preferred Shares. In addition, we recorded an additional $19.4 million beneficial conversion feature charge in fiscal 2010 related to dividends that have accrued and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. We expect to recognize additional beneficial conversion feature charges in the future as paid-in-kind dividends are accrued on the Convertible Preferred Stock to the extent each day’s stock price is in excess of $6.3740, the conversion price applicable to the Convertible Preferred Stock.

Diluted loss per common share decreased to a loss of $(17.07) per diluted share for fiscal 2010, compared to a loss of $(171.18) per diluted share for the prior year. The decrease in the diluted loss per share was predominantly due to a $451.3 million decrease in net loss applicable to shares of our Common Stock resulting from the factors described above in this section. In addition, the weighted average number of Common Shares outstanding increased by 13.8 million due in large part to the Exchange Offer. In connection with the Exchange Offer, we issued 14.0 million shares of Common Stock. In addition to the Exchange Offer, our 2009 refinancing transaction included the issuance of $250 million of shares of Convertible Preferred Stock which required the use of the “two-class” method in determining diluted earnings per share for fiscal 2010, but did not increase the weighted average number of Common Shares outstanding. At October 31, 2010, the Preferred Shares were convertible into 44.3 million shares of Common Stock. In addition, the Convertible Preferred Stock and the unvested restricted Common Stock related to our Incentive Plan do not have a contractual obligation to share in losses; therefore, no losses were allocated in both periods presented. These participating securities will be allocated earnings when applicable.

 

50


Table of Contents

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

General

Working capital was $137.6 million and $147.5 million at October 30, 2011 and October 30, 2010, respectively. The $9.9 million decrease in working capital during fiscal 2011 was primarily due to a $14.6 million decrease in income taxes receivable due to a federal income tax refund received in April 2011 and a $17.6 million increase in accounts payable due to timing of payments, partially offset by a $13.5 million increase in accounts receivable which was driven by higher underlying transaction prices and a $7.1 million increase in inventory also due higher underlying steel costs.

Cash provided by (used in) operating activities was $41.4 million and $6.3 million for fiscal 2011 and fiscal 2010, respectively. The $41.4 million increase in cash provided by operating activities during fiscal 2011 was attributed to significantly improved earnings, partially offset by the $9.9 million decrease in working capital.

Cash used in investing activities was $20.5 million and $13.3 million for fiscal 2011 and fiscal 2010, respectively. The $20.5 million used in investing activities during fiscal 2011 was primarily attributable to $21.0 million used for capital expenditures predominantly related to two newly retooled insulated panel system facilities, computer software and machinery and equipment.

Cash used in financing activities was $19.4 million and $6.0 million for fiscal 2011 and fiscal 2010, respectively. The $19.4 million used in financing activities during fiscal 2011 was primarily attributable to $11.0 million of dividends paid in cash on the Convertible Preferred Stock, $6.8 million of note payable and term loan payments and $1.5 million of restricted stock that was repurchased as treasury shares to satisfy tax-withholding obligations arising in connection with the vesting of awards of restricted stock.

We invest our excess cash in various overnight investments which are issued or guaranteed by the federal government.

Convertible Preferred Stock

On October 20, 2009, we closed the $250.0 million equity investment by the CD&R Funds in the Company. As a result of that equity investment, the CD&R Funds acquired 250,000 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock (such purchase and sale, the “CD&R Equity Investment”), which represented 68.4% of the then voting power and Common Stock of the Company on an as-converted basis. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the Preferred Shares, including shares issued as in-kind dividends on the CD&R Equity Investment, were convertible into approximately 46.6 million and 44.3 million shares of Common Stock, respectively, at an initial conversion price of $6.3740 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split).

At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had 286,701 and 272,503 Preferred Shares outstanding, respectively. In addition, at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had accrued but unpaid cash and in-kind dividends on the Preferred Shares with a value of $10.1 million and $10.0 million, respectively. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the aggregate liquidation preference plus aggregate accrued dividends of the Convertible Preferred Stock was $296.8 million and $282.5 million, respectively.

Our Amended Credit Agreement currently restricts the payment of cash dividends to 50% of cumulative earnings beginning with the fourth quarter of 2009, and in the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan of which we used $11.0 million as of October 30, 2011. We paid the first two quarters of fiscal 2011 dividends on the Preferred Shares totalling $11.0 million in cash. We paid the June 15, 2011 dividend payment on the Preferred Shares in-kind. The determination of cash payment versus payment-in-kind or “PIK” of the Convertible Preferred Stock dividends will be made each quarter adhering to the limitations of our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility as well as the Company’s intermediate and long term cash flow requirements.

 

51


Table of Contents

We paid the September 15, 2011 dividend payment on the Preferred Shares in-kind. On September 6, 2011, we entered into a Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock, agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended September 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares, and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the remainder of its fiscal year ending October 30, 2011, subject to certain exceptions.

The September 6, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after September 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 30, 2011.

On December 9, 2011, we entered into a second Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock, agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended December 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares, and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the fiscal year ending October 28, 2012, subject to certain exceptions.

The December 9, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after December 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 28, 2012.

Debt

We have an Amended Credit Agreement which includes an initial $150 million in term loans. The term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement will mature on April 20, 2014 and, prior to that date, we are required to pay quarterly installments equal to 0.25% of the principal amount of the term loan then outstanding as of the last day of each calendar quarter. However, we made a mandatory prepayment on the Amended Credit Agreement in May 2010 in connection with our tax refund received resulting from the carry back of the 2009 net operating loss. In fiscal 2011, we made optional prepayments in the amount of $5.6 million. These prepayments are allowed to be applied against the required quarterly principal payments, and as a result, we are not required to make the above mentioned quarterly principal payments for the remaining term of the term loans. In addition, these prepayments have deferred our leverage ratio covenant until the first quarter of fiscal 2013. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, amounts outstanding under our Amended Credit Agreement were $130.7 million and $136.3 million, respectively.

In addition to our Amended Credit Agreement, we have an ABL Facility which allows aggregate maximum borrowings of up to $125.0 million; however, the aggregate maximum borrowings are limited to $100.0 million under our Amended Credit Agreement. Borrowing availability on the ABL Facility is determined by a monthly borrowing base collateral calculation that is based on specified percentages of the value of qualified cash, eligible inventory and eligible accounts receivable, less certain reserves and subject to certain other adjustments. The ABL Facility has a maturity of April 20, 2014 and includes borrowing capacity of up to $25 million for letters of credit and up to $10 million for swingline borrowings.

Amended Credit Agreement. The Company’s obligations under the Amended Credit Agreement and any interest rate protection agreements or other permitted hedging agreement entered into with any lender under the Amended Credit Agreement are irrevocably and unconditionally guaranteed on a joint and several basis by each direct and indirect domestic subsidiary of the Company (other than any domestic subsidiary that is a foreign

 

52


Table of Contents

subsidiary holding company or a subsidiary of a foreign subsidiary). Our obligations under the Amended Credit Agreement and the permitted hedging agreements and the guarantees thereof are secured pursuant to a guarantee and collateral agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, made by the Company and other grantors (as defined therein), in favor of the term loan administrative agent and term loan collateral agent, by (i) all of the capital stock and other equity interests of all direct domestic subsidiaries owned by the Company and the guarantors, (ii) up to 65% of the capital stock of certain direct foreign subsidiaries of the Company or any guarantor (it being understood that a foreign subsidiary holding company or a domestic subsidiary of a foreign subsidiary will be deemed a foreign subsidiary) and (iii) substantially all other tangible and intangible assets owned by the Company and each guarantor, including liens on material real property, in each case to the extent permitted by applicable law and subject to certain enumerated exceptions. The liens securing the obligations under the Amended Credit Agreement, the permitted hedging agreements and the guarantees thereof are first in priority (as between the Amended Credit Agreement and the ABL Facility) with respect to stock, material real property and assets other than accounts receivable, inventory, certain deposit accounts, associated intangibles and certain other specified assets of the Company and the guarantors. Such liens are second in priority (as between the Amended Credit Agreement and the ABL Facility) with respect to accounts receivable, inventory, associated intangibles of the Company and certain other specified assets of the guarantors. As of October 30, 2011, we do not have any outstanding interest rate hedges.

The Amended Credit Agreement contains a number of covenants that, among other things, limit or restrict our ability to dispose of assets, incur additional indebtedness, incur guarantee obligations, prepay other indebtedness, make dividends and other restricted payments, create liens, make investments, make acquisitions, engage in mergers, change the nature of our business and engage in certain transactions with affiliates.

The Amended Credit Agreement has no financial covenants until October 30, 2011 (subject to prepayment deferrals as noted below), at which time our consolidated leverage ratio of net indebtedness to EBITDA must be no more than 5 to 1. Net indebtedness is defined as consolidated debt less the lesser of unrestricted cash or $50 million. This ratio steps down by 0.25 each quarter until October 28, 2012 at which time the maximum ratio is 4 to 1. The ratio continues to step down by 0.125 each quarter until November 3, 2013 to a ratio of 3.5 to 1, which remains the maximum ratio for each fiscal quarter thereafter. We will, however, not be subject to this financial covenant with respect to a specified period if certain prepayments or repurchases of the term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement are made in the specified period. Based on our prepayments made through October 30, 2011, the leverage ratio covenant has been deferred until the first quarter of fiscal 2013. The prepayments that have been made can be applied to continuously defer covenant requirements and are not reduced unless the Company’s actual leverage ratios are above the maximum requirement for a given period. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, our consolidated leverage ratio was 2.27 and 5.36, respectively.

Term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement may be repaid at any time, without premium or penalty but subject to customary LIBOR breakage costs. We also have the ability to repurchase a portion of the term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement, subject to certain terms and conditions set forth in the Amended Credit Agreement. In addition, the term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement are subject to mandatory prepayment and reduction in an amount equal to:

 

   

the net cash proceeds of (1) certain asset sales, (2) certain debt offerings and (3) certain insurance recovery and condemnation events; and

 

   

50% of annual excess cash flow (as defined in the Amended Credit Agreement) for any fiscal year ending on or after October 31, 2010, unless a specified leverage ratio target of 4 to 1 is met.

Term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement bear interest, at our option, as follows:

(1) Base Rate loans at the Base Rate plus a margin. After October 30, 2011, the margin fluctuates based on our leverage ratio and shall be either 5% or 3.5% if our leverage ratio is less than 3.5 to 1. As of the first fiscal quarter commencing January 30, 2012, the margin in each case increases by 0.25% per annum on the first day of each fiscal quarter unless the aggregate principal amount of term loans outstanding under the

 

53


Table of Contents

Amended Credit Agreement in the immediately preceding fiscal quarter of the Company has been reduced by $3,750,000 (excluding scheduled principal amortization payments), less any prior reductions not previously applied to prevent an increase in the applicable margin, and

(2) LIBOR loans at LIBOR (having a minimum rate of 2%) plus a margin. After October 30, 2011, the LIBOR-linked margin fluctuates based on our leverage ratio and shall be either 6% or 4.5% if our leverage ratio is less than 3.5 to 1. As of the first fiscal quarter commencing January 30, 2012, the margin in each case increases by 0.25% per annum on the first day of each fiscal quarter unless the aggregate principal amount of term loans outstanding under the Amended Credit Agreement in the immediately preceding fiscal quarter of the Company has been reduced by $3,750,000 (excluding scheduled principal amortization payments), less any prior reductions not previously applied to prevent an increase in the applicable margin. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the interest rate on our Amended Credit Agreement was 8.0%. Based on our leverage ratio at October 30, 2011, the applicable margin in the first quarter of fiscal 2012 will be 4.5%.

Overdue amounts will bear interest at a rate that is 2% higher than the rate otherwise applicable. “Base rate” is defined as the highest of (i) the Wells Fargo Bank, National Association prime rate; (ii) the overnight Federal Funds rate plus 0.5%; and (iii) 3.0% and “LIBOR” is defined as the applicable London interbank offered rate (not to be less than 2%) adjusted for reserves.

ABL Facility. The ABL Facility provides for an asset-based revolving credit facility which allows aggregate maximum borrowings by NCI Group, Inc. and Robertson-Ceco II Corporation of up to $125.0 million; however, the aggregate maximum borrowings are limited to $100.0 million under our Amended Credit Agreement. Borrowing availability under the ABL Facility is determined by a monthly borrowing base collateral calculation that is based on specified percentages of the value of qualified cash, eligible inventory and eligible accounts receivable, less certain reserves and subject to certain other adjustments. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, our excess availability under the ABL Facility was $87.8 million and $73.8 million, respectively. Under the ABL Facility, there were no amounts of borrowings outstanding at both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010. In addition, at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, letters of credit totaling approximately $6.4 million and $8.1 million, respectively, were outstanding under the ABL Facility.

On December 3, 2010, we finalized an amendment of our ABL Facility that reduces the unused commitment fee from 1% or 0.75% based on the average daily balance of loans and letters of credit obligations outstanding to an annual rate of 0.5%, reduces the effective interest rate on borrowings, if any, by nearly 40% or 175 basis points and relaxes the prohibitions against making restricted cash payments or paying cash dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock, to allow, in the aggregate, up to $6.5 million of restricted payments or cash dividends each calendar quarter, provided (i) certain excess availability conditions or (ii) certain other excess availability conditions and a fixed charge coverage ratio under the ABL Facility are satisfied.

An unused commitment fee is paid monthly on the ABL Facility at an annual rate of 0.50% based on the amount by which the maximum credit exceeds the average daily principal balance of outstanding loans and letter of credit obligations. Additional customary fees in connection with the ABL Facility also apply.

The obligations of the borrowers under the ABL Facility are guaranteed by the Company and each direct and indirect domestic subsidiary of the Company (other than any domestic subsidiary that is a foreign subsidiary holding company or a subsidiary of a foreign subsidiary) that is not a borrower under the ABL Facility. The obligations of the Company under certain specified bank products agreements are guaranteed by each borrower and each other direct and indirect domestic subsidiary of the Company and the other guarantors. These guarantees are made pursuant to a guarantee agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, entered into by the Company and each other guarantor with Wells Fargo Foothill, LLC, as administrative agent.

The obligations under the ABL Facility, and the guarantees thereof, are secured by a first priority lien on our accounts receivable, inventory, certain deposit accounts, associated intangibles and certain other specified assets of the Company and a second priority lien on the assets securing the term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement on a first-lien basis, in each case subject to certain exceptions.

 

54


Table of Contents

The ABL Facility contains a number of covenants that, among other things, limit or restrict our ability to dispose of assets, incur additional indebtedness, incur guarantee obligations, engage in sale and leaseback transactions, prepay other indebtedness, modify organizational documents and certain other agreements, create restrictions affecting subsidiaries, make dividends and other restricted payments, create liens, make investments, make acquisitions, engage in mergers, change the nature of our business and engage in certain transactions with affiliates.

Under the ABL Facility, a “Dominion Event” occurs if either an event of default is continuing or excess availability falls below certain levels, during which period, and for certain periods thereafter, the administrative agent may apply all amounts in the Company’s, the borrowers’ and the other guarantors’ concentration accounts to the repayment of the loans outstanding under the ABL Facility, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement and certain specified exceptions. In addition, during such Dominion Event, we are required to make mandatory payments on our ABL Facility upon the occurrence of certain events, including the sale of assets and the issuance of debt, in each case subject to certain limitations and conditions set forth in the ABL Facility.

The ABL Facility includes a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of one to one, which will apply if we fail to maintain at least $15.0 million of borrowing capacity. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, our fixed charge coverage ratio was 0.37 and 1.01, respectively.

Loans under the ABL Facility bear interest, at our option, as follows:

(1) Base Rate loans at the Base Rate plus a margin. The margin ranges from 1.50% to 2.00% depending on the quarterly average excess availability under such facility, and

(2) LIBOR loans at LIBOR plus a margin. The margin ranges from 2.50% to 3.00% depending on the quarterly average excess availability under such facility. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the interest rate on our ABL Facility was 4.75% and 6.50%, respectively.

During an event of default, loans under the ABL Facility will bear at a rate that is 2% higher than the rate otherwise applicable. “Base Rate” is defined as the higher of the Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. prime rate and the overnight Federal Funds rate plus 0.5% and “LIBOR” is defined as the applicable London interbank offered rate adjusted for reserves.

Foreign Currency Contracts

We are exposed to foreign currency risk associated with fluctuations in the foreign currency exchange rates on certain purchase orders denominated in a foreign currency related to the purchase of certain equipment. During fiscal 2011, we entered into various forward contracts to pay U.S. dollars and receive Euros. All contracts have been designated as cash flow hedges. The fair value of the foreign currency contracts is $0.04 million at October 30, 2011. The foreign currency contracts take into consideration the current creditworthiness of us or the counterparty, as applicable, and are included in prepaid expense and other in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Accumulated other comprehensive income will amortize over the life of the equipment purchased.

Cash Flow

We periodically evaluate our liquidity requirements, capital needs and availability of resources in view of inventory levels, expansion plans, debt service requirements and other operating cash needs. To meet our short- and long-term liquidity requirements, including payment of operating expenses and repaying debt, we rely primarily on cash from operations. Beyond cash generated from operations, we have an undrawn ABL Facility with $87.8 million available at October 30, 2011 and $79.0 million of unrestricted cash at October 30, 2011. However, we have recently, as well as in the past, sought to raise additional capital.

We expect that, for the next 12 months, cash generated from operations will be sufficient to provide us the ability to fund our operations, provide the increased working capital necessary to support our strategy and fund planned capital expenditures of between approximately $30 million and $35 million for fiscal 2012 and expansion when needed.

 

55


Table of Contents

In the past, we have used available funds to repurchase shares of our Common Stock under our stock repurchase program though we have no intention to repurchase shares in the near-term. Although we did not purchase any Common Stock during fiscal 2011 under the stock repurchase program, we did withhold shares of restricted stock to satisfy tax withholding obligations arising in connection with the vesting of awards of restricted stock related to our 2003 Long-Term Stock Incentive Plan.

Our corporate strategy seeks potential acquisitions which provide additional synergies in our metal coil coating, metal components and engineered building systems segments. From time to time, we may enter into letters of intent or agreements to acquire assets or companies in these business lines. The consummation of these transactions could require cash payments and/or issuance of additional debt.

The Company may from time to time repurchase or otherwise retire the Company’s debt and take other steps to reduce the Company’s debt or otherwise improve the Company’s financial position. These actions may include open market debt repurchases, negotiated repurchases, other retirements of outstanding debt and opportunistic refinancing of debt. The amount of debt that may be repurchased or otherwise retired, if any, will depend on market conditions, trading levels of the Company’s debt, the Company’s cash position, compliance with debt covenants and other considerations. Affiliates of the Company may also purchase the Company’s debt from time to time, through open market purchases or other transactions. In such cases, the Company’s debt may not be retired, in which case the Company would continue to pay interest in accordance with the terms of the debt, and the Company would continue to reflect the debt as outstanding in its Consolidated Balance Sheets.

Steel Prices

Our business is heavily dependent on the price and supply of steel. Our various products are fabricated from steel produced by mills to forms including bars, plates, structural shapes, sheets, hot-rolled coils and galvanized or Galvalume®-coated coils. The steel industry is highly cyclical in nature, and steel prices have been volatile in recent years and may remain volatile in the future. Steel prices are influenced by numerous factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions, domestically and internationally, the availability of raw materials, competition, labor costs, freight and transportation costs, production costs, import duties and other trade restrictions. We believe the CRU North American Steel Price Index, published by the CRU Group since 1994 appropriately depicts the volatility in steel prices. See “Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk — Steel Prices.” During fiscal 2011 and 2010, steel prices fluctuated significantly due to market conditions ranging from a high point on the CRU Index of 219 to a low point of 146 in fiscal 2011 and fluctuated significantly from a high point on the CRU Index of 182 to a low point of 140 in fiscal 2010. Given the level of steel industry consolidation, the anticipated additional domestic market capacity from new entrants, generally low inventories in the industry and slow economic recovery, we believe steel prices will continue to be volatile and will be slightly higher, on average, in fiscal 2012 as compared with the prices we experienced during fiscal 2011.

Although we have the ability to purchase steel from a number of suppliers, a production cutback by one or more of our current suppliers could create challenges in meeting delivery schedules to our customers. Because we have periodically adjusted our contract prices, particularly in the engineered building systems segment, we have generally been able to pass increases in our raw material costs through to our customers. Because the metal coil coating and metal components segments have shorter lead times, they have the ability to react to steel price increases closer to the time they occur without revising contract prices for existing orders. For additional discussion please see “Item 1A. Risk Factors.”

We rely on a few major suppliers for our supply of steel and may be adversely affected by the bankruptcy, change in control, financial condition or other factors affecting those suppliers. During fiscal 2011, we purchased approximately 33% of our steel requirements from two vendors in the United States. No other vendor accounted for over 10% of our steel requirements during fiscal 2011. Due to unfavorable market conditions and our

 

56


Table of Contents

inventory supply requirements, during fiscal 2011, we purchased insignificant amounts of steel from foreign suppliers. Limiting purchases to domestic suppliers further reduces our available steel supply base. For additional information about the risks of our raw material supply and pricing, see “Item 1A. Risk Factors.”

NON-GAAP MEASURES

Set forth below are certain non-GAAP measures which include adjusted operating income (loss), adjusted diluted earnings (loss) per common share and adjusted EBITDA. Such measurements are not prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP and should not be construed as an alternative to reported results determined in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Management believes the use of such non-GAAP measures on a consolidated and business segment basis assists investors in understanding the ongoing operating performance by presenting the financial results between periods on a more comparable basis. In addition, certain financial covenants related to our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility are based on similar non-GAAP measures. The non-GAAP information provided is unique to the Company and may not be consistent with the methodologies used by other companies.

The following tables reconcile adjusted operating income (loss) to operating income (loss) for the periods indicated (in thousands):

 

     For the Three Months Ended October 30, 2011  
     Metal Coil
Coating
     Metal
Components
     Engineered
Building
Systems
     Corporate     Consolidated  

Operating income (loss), GAAP basis

   $ 4,903       $ 6,345       $ 10,698       $ (14,162   $ 7,784   

Asset impairments

     —           9         958         247        1,214   

Restructuring charges

     —           —           283         —          283   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Adjusted” operating income (loss)

   $ 4,903       $ 6,354       $ 11,939       $ (13,915   $ 9,281   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     For the Three Months Ended October 31, 2010  
     Metal Coil
Coating
     Metal
Components
     Engineered
Building
Systems
    Corporate     Consolidated  

Operating income (loss), GAAP basis

   $ 3,754       $ 8,820       $ (3,859   $ (12,489   $ (3,774

Asset impairments

     —           221         —          —          221   

Restructuring charges

     —           95         1,533        —          1,628   

Environmental and other contingency adjustments

     —           —           178        —          178   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Adjusted” operating income (loss)

   $ 3,754       $ 9,136       $ (2,148   $ (12,489   $ (1,747
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     For the Year Ended October 30, 2011  
     Metal Coil
Coating
     Metal
Components
    Engineered
Building
Systems
    Corporate     Consolidated  

Operating income (loss), GAAP basis

   $ 17,944       $ 20,643      $ 13,011      $ (53,225   $ (1,627

Asset impairments (recoveries)

     —           (84     958        247        1,121   

Restructuring recovery

     —           —          (292     —          (292

Pre-acquisition contingency adjustment

     —           —          252        —          252   

Increase in actuarial determined general liability self-insurance reserve

     —           2,398        —          —          2,398   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Adjusted” operating income (loss)

   $ 17,944       $ 22,957      $ 13,929      $ (52,978   $ 1,852   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

57


Table of Contents
     For the Year Ended October 31, 2010  
     Metal Coil
Coating
     Metal
Components
     Engineered
Building
Systems
    Corporate     Consolidated  

Operating income (loss), GAAP basis

   $ 16,166       $ 26,791       $ (18,438   $ (49,106   $ (24,587

Asset impairments

     —           147         923        —          1,070   

Restructuring charges

     —           510         3,022        —          3,532   

Environmental and other contingency adjustments

     —           —           178        —          178   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Adjusted” operating income (loss)

   $ 16,166       $ 27,448       $ (14,315   $ (49,106   $ (19,807
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table reconciles adjusted EBITDA to Net income (loss) for the periods indicated (in thousands):

 

    1st Quarter
January 30, 2011
    2nd Quarter
May 1, 2011
    3rd Quarter
July 31,  2011
    4th Quarter
October 30,  2011
    Trailing 12
Months
October 30, 2011
 

Net income (loss)

  $ (12,725   $ (3,229   $ 2,593      $ 3,411      $ (9,950

Add:

         

Depreciation and amortization

    7,236        7,187        7,187        6,753        28,363   

Consolidated interest expense, net

    4,177        3,870        3,864        3,685        15,596   

Provision (benefit) from income taxes

    (5,009     (1,786     —          398        (6,397

Non — cash charges:

         

Stock — based compensation

    1,685        1,671        1,776        1,776        6,908   

Asset impairments (recoveries)

    —          —          (93     1,214        1,121   

Embedded derivative

    (7     (6     (6     (6     (25

Pre-acquisition contingency adjustment

    252        —          —          —          252   

Cash restructuring charges (recoveries)

    —          —          (575     283        (292

Transaction costs

    —          —          —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

  $ (4,391   $ 7,707      $ 14,746      $ 17,514      $ 35,576   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    1st Quarter
January 31, 2010
    2nd Quarter
May 2, 2010
    3rd Quarter
August 1,  2010
    4th Quarter
October 31,  2010
    Trailing 12
Months
October 31, 2010
 

Net income (loss)

  $ (10,486   $ (7,656   $ (3,299   $ (5,436   $ (26,877

Add:

         

Depreciation and amortization

    7,521        7,480        7,457        7,309        29,767   

Consolidated interest expense, net

    4,507        4,670        4,392        4,258        17,827   

Benefit from income taxes

    (5,779     (5,536     (221     (1,794     (13,330

Non — cash charges:

         

Stock — based compensation

    801        1,403        1,374        1,375        4,953   

Asset impairments (recoveries)

    1,029        (116     (64     221        1,070   

Embedded derivative

    (919     (4     (7     (7     (937

Pre-acquisition contingency adjustment

    —          —          —          178        178   

Cash restructuring charges

    524        829        551        1,628        3,532   

Transaction costs

    174        —          —          (250     (76
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

  $ (2,628   $ 1,070      $ 10,183      $ 7,482      $ 16,107   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

58


Table of Contents

The following tables reconcile adjusted diluted loss per common share to loss per diluted common share and adjusted loss applicable to common shares to loss applicable to common shares for the periods indicated (in thousands):

 

     Fiscal Three Months Ended     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Net loss per diluted common share, GAAP basis(1)

   $ (0.24   $ (1.01   $ (2.58   $ (17.07

Refinancing costs, net of taxes

     —          (0.01     —          (0.00

Convertible preferred stock beneficial conversion feature

     0.07        0.23        0.51        13.73   

Restructuring charges (recovery), net of taxes

     0.01        0.05        (0.01     0.12   

Asset impairments, net of taxes

     0.04        0.01        0.04        0.03   

Gain on embedded derivative, net of taxes

     (0.00     (0.00     (0.00     (0.03

Increase in actuarial determined general liability self-insurance reserve, net of taxes

     —          —          0.08        —     

Pre-acquisition contingency adjustment, net of taxes

     —          0.01        0.01        0.01   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Adjusted” loss per diluted common share

   $ (0.11   $ (0.72   $ (1.96   $ (3.21
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Fiscal Three Months Ended     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Net loss applicable to common shares, GAAP basis(1)

   $ (4,399   $ (18,556   $ (47,466   $ (311,227

Refinancing costs, net of taxes

     —          (163     —          (49

Convertible preferred stock beneficial conversion feature

     1,356        4,242        9,396        250,294   

Restructuring charges (recovery), net of taxes

     174        1,058        (180     2,296   

Asset impairments, net of taxes

     748        144        691        696   

Gain on embedded derivative, net of taxes

     (4     (4     (16     (609

Increase in actuarial determined general liability self-insurance reserve, net of taxes

     —          —          1,477        —     

Pre-acquisition contingency adjustment, net of taxes

     —          116        181        116   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Adjusted” net loss applicable to common shares

   $ (2,125   $ (13,163   $ (35,917   $ (58,483
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Adjusted to reflect the 1-for-5 Reverse Stock Split effected on March 5, 2010.

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

As part of our ongoing business, we do not participate in transactions that generate relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial partnerships, such as entities often referred to as structured finance or special purpose entities (“SPEs”), which would have been established for the purpose of facilitating off-balance sheet arrangements or other contractually narrow or limited purposes. As of October 30, 2011, we were not involved in any unconsolidated SPE transactions.

 

59


Table of Contents

CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

The following table shows our contractual obligations as of October 30, 2011 (in thousands):

 

     Payments due by period  

Contractual Obligation

   Total      Less than
1  year
     1-3 years      4-5
years
     More than
5 years
 

Total debt

   $ 130,699       $ —         $ 130,699       $ —         $ —     

Interest payments on debt(1)

     40,456         14,199         26,257         —           —     

Convertible Preferred Stock dividend(2)

     298,626         23,672         53,359         62,519         159,076   

Operating leases

     8,600         3,560         3,115         1,096         829   

Other purchase obligations(3)

     6,625         4,208         2,417         —           —     

Projected pension obligations(4)

     8,877         1,607         3,082         2,871         1,317   

Other long-term obligations(5)

     819         254         538         27         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total contractual obligations

   $ 494,702       $ 47,500       $ 219,467       $ 66,513       $ 161,222   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Interest payments were calculated based on rates in effect at October 30, 2011 for variable rate obligations.
(2) We have the option to pay dividends required by our Convertible Preferred Stock in cash or paid in-kind beginning in fiscal 2011. For simplicity, we have assumed cash dividends of 8% will be paid until the Convertible Preferred Stock can be either called by us or put to us by the CD&R funds on the tenth anniversary of the Closing Date. However, if at any time after the 30 month anniversary of the Closing Date, the trading price of the common stock of the Company exceeds $12.75, which is 200% of the initial conversion price (as defined in the Certificate of Designation), for each of 20 consecutive trading days, the dividend rate (excluding any applicable adjustments as a result of a default) will become 0.00%.
(3) Includes various agreements for steel delivery obligations, gas contracts, transportation services and telephone service obligations. In general, purchase orders issued in the normal course of business can be terminated in whole or part for any reason without liability until the product is received. Steel consignment inventory from our suppliers does not constitute a purchase commitment and are not included in our table of contractual obligations. However, it is our current practice to purchase all consignment inventory that remains in consignment after an agreed term. Consignment inventory at October 30, 2011 is estimated to be approximately $17 million.
(4) Amounts represent our estimate of the minimum funding requirements as determined by government regulations. Amounts are subject to change based on numerous assumptions, including the performance of the assets in the plan and bond rates.
(5) Includes contractual payments and projected supplemental retirement benefits to or on behalf of former executives.

CONTINGENT LIABILITIES AND COMMITMENTS

Our insurance carriers require us to secure standby letters of credit as a collateral requirement for our projected exposure to future period claims growth and loss development which includes incurred but not reported, or IBNR, claims. For all insurance carriers, the total standby letters of credit are approximately $9.1 million and $10.8 million at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, respectively.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Our Consolidated Financial Statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, which require us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates, including those estimates that may have a significant effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Our significant accounting policies are disclosed in Note 2 to our Consolidated Financial Statements. The following discussion of critical accounting policies addresses those policies that are

 

60


Table of Contents

both important to the portrayal of our financial condition and results of operations and require significant judgment and estimates. We base our estimates and judgment on historical experience and on various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.

Revenue recognition. We recognize revenues when all of the following conditions are met: persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has occurred or services have been rendered, the price is fixed or determinable, and collectibility is reasonably assured. Generally, these criteria are met at the time product is shipped or services are complete. Provisions are made upon the sale for estimated product returns. Costs associated with shipping and handling our products are included in cost of sales.

Insurance accruals. We have a self-funded Administrative Services Only (“ASO”) arrangement for our employee group health insurance. We purchase individual stop-loss protection to cap our medical claims liability at $250,000 per claim. Each reporting period, we record the costs of our health insurance plan, including paid claims, an estimate of the change in incurred but not reported (“IBNR”) claims, taxes and administrative fees, when applicable, (collectively the “Plan Costs”) as general and administrative expenses and cost of sales in our Consolidated Statements of Operations. The estimated IBNR claims are based upon (i) a recent average level of paid claims under the plan, (ii) an estimated claims lag factor and (iii) an estimated claims growth factor to provide for those claims that have been incurred but not yet paid. We have deductible programs for our Workers Compensation/Employer Liability and Auto Liability insurance policies, and a self-insured retention (“SIR”) arrangement for our General Liability insurance policy. The Workers Compensation/Employer Liability deductible is $500,000 per occurrence. The Property and Auto Liability deductibles are $50,000 and $250,000, respectively, per occurrence. The General Liability has a self-insured retention of $350,000 per occurrence. For workers’ compensation costs, we monitor the number of accidents and the severity of such accidents to develop appropriate estimates for expected costs to provide both medical care and indemnity benefits, when applicable, for the period of time that an employee is incapacitated and unable to work. These accruals are developed using third-party insurance adjuster reserve estimates of the expected cost for medical treatment, and length of time an employee will be unable to work based on industry statistics for the cost of similar disabilities and statutory impairment ratings. For general liability and automobile claims, accruals are developed based on third-party insurance adjuster reserve estimates of the expected cost to resolve each claim, including damages and defense costs, based on legal and industry trends, and the nature and severity of the claim. Accruals also include estimates for IBNR claims, and taxes and administrative fees, when applicable. This statistical information is trended by a third-party actuary to provide estimates of future expected costs based on loss development factors derived from our period-to-period growth of our claims costs to full maturity (ultimate), versus original estimates.

We believe that the assumptions and information used to develop these accruals provide the best basis for these estimates each quarter because, as a general matter, the accruals have historically proven to be reasonable and accurate. However, significant changes in expected medical and health care costs, negative changes in the severity of previously reported claims or changes in laws that govern the administration of these plans could have an impact on the determination of the amount of these accruals in future periods. Our methodology for determining the amount of health insurance accrual considers claims growth and claims lag, which is the length of time between the incurred date and processing date. For the health insurance accrual, a change of 10% in the lag assumption would result in a financial impact of $0.3 million.

Share-Based Compensation. Under ASC Topic 718, Compensation - Stock Compensation, the fair value and compensation expense of each option award is estimated as of the date of grant using a Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing formula. Expected volatility is based on historical volatility of our stock over a preceding period commensurate with the expected term of the option. The expected volatility considers factors such as the volatility of our share price, implied volatility of our share price, length of time our shares have been publicly traded, appropriate and regular intervals for price observations and our corporate and capital structure. The

 

61


Table of Contents

forfeiture rate in our calculation of share-based compensation expense is based on historical experience and is estimated at 10% for our non-officers and 0% for our officers. The risk-free rate for the expected term of the option is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant. Expected dividend yield was not considered in the option pricing formula since we historically have not paid dividends on our common shares and have no current plans to do so in the future. We granted 0.1 million and 1.8 million options during the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, respectively. There were no options granted during the fiscal year ended November 1, 2009.

The compensation cost related to these share-based awards is recognized over the requisite service period. The requisite service period is generally the period during which an employee is required to provide service in exchange for the award.

Our option awards and restricted stock awards are subject to graded vesting over a service period, which is typically four years. We recognize compensation cost for these awards on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for the entire award. In addition, certain of our awards provide for accelerated vesting upon qualified retirement. We recognize compensation cost for such awards over the period from grant date to the date the employee first becomes eligible for retirement.

Income taxes. The determination of our provision for income taxes requires significant judgment, the use of estimates and the interpretation and application of complex tax laws. Our provision for income taxes reflects a combination of income earned and taxed in the various U.S. federal and state, Canadian federal and provincial as well as Mexican federal jurisdictions. Jurisdictional tax law changes, increases or decreases in permanent differences between book and tax items, accruals or adjustments of accruals for tax contingencies or valuation allowances, and the change in the mix of earnings from these taxing jurisdictions all affect the overall effective tax rate.

At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had a full valuation allowance in the amount of $5.4 million and $5.2 million, respectively, on the deferred tax assets of Robertson Building Systems Ltd., our Canadian subsidiary.

As of October 30, 2011, the $11.2 million net operating loss carryforward consisted of $5.1 million for foreign loss carryforward, $4.0 million for U.S. federal loss carryforward and $2.1 million of U.S. state loss carryforward. The U.S. federal net operating loss carried forward is the fiscal 2011 taxable loss which is approximately $10.3 million and represents $4.0 million of deferred tax asset. This loss will expire, if unused, by fiscal 2031. As of October 30, 2011, we have deferred tax assets of $2.1 million related to state net operating loss carryforwards which will expire in 3 to 20 years, if unused.

We expect to generate sufficient operating profits in future periods to fully utilize our net deferred tax assets of $13.1 million. In evaluating our expectations, we have evaluated a variety of factors including multiple industry sources citing continued growth in the nonresidential construction market into 2012 and 2013, our continued market strength in the commercial and industrial subsectors of the nonresidential market that are experiencing growth above that of the overall nonresidential construction market and our internal forecast projections which we believe will continue the profitable trends experienced in the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2011. Our expectations could change in the near term if nonresidential construction fails to continue its projected recovery. In the event our operating results or expectations of future operating results change, a valuation allowance may be required on our existing unreserved net U.S. deferred tax assets.

Accounting for acquisitions, intangible assets and goodwill. Accounting for the acquisition of a business requires the allocation of the purchase price to the various assets and liabilities of the acquired business. For most assets and liabilities, purchase price allocation is accomplished by recording the asset or liability at its estimated fair value. The most difficult estimations of individual fair values are those involving property, plant and equipment and identifiable intangible assets. We use all available information to make these fair value determinations and, for major business acquisitions such as RCC, typically engage an outside appraisal firm to assist in the fair value determination of the acquired long-lived assets.

 

62


Table of Contents

In connection with the acquisition of Garco, we recorded intangible assets for trade names, backlog, customer relationships and non-competition agreements in the amount of $0.8 million, $0.7 million, $2.5 million and $1.8 million, respectively. All Garco intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their expected useful lives. Garco’s trade names are being amortized over 15 years based on our expectation of our use of the trade names. Garco’s backlog was amortized over one year because items in Garco’s backlog were expected to be delivered within one year. Garco’s customer lists and relationships are being amortized over fifteen years based on a review of the historical length of Garco’s customer retention experience. Garco’s non-competition agreements are being amortized over their agreement terms of five years.

In connection with the acquisition of RCC, we recorded intangible assets for trade names, backlog and customer relationships in the amount of $24.7 million, $2.3 million and $6.3 million, respectively. Trade names were determined to have indefinite useful lives and so are not amortized. Trade names were determined to have indefinite lives due to the length of time the trade names have been in place, with some having been in place for decades. Our past practice with other acquisitions and our current intentions are to maintain the trade names indefinitely. This judgmental assessment of an indefinite useful life must be continuously evaluated in the future. If, due to changes in facts and circumstances, management determines that these intangible assets then have definite useful lives, amortization will commence at that time on a prospective basis. As long as these intangible assets are judged to have indefinite lives, they will be subject to periodic impairment tests that require management’s judgment of the estimated fair value of these intangible assets. We assess impairment of our non-amortizing intangibles at least annually in accordance with ASC Topic 350, Intangibles — Goodwill and Other (“ASC 350”). All other intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their expected useful lives. RCC’s customer relationships are being amortized over fifteen years based on a review of the historical length of RCC’s customer retention experience. See Note 6 — Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, for additional information.

Prior to the goodwill impairment charges recorded in fiscal 2009, we recorded approximately $277.3 million of goodwill as a result of the RCC acquisition. Goodwill of $17.0 million, $17.8 million and $242.5 million had been recorded in our metal coil coating, metal components and engineered building systems segments, respectively. We perform a test for impairment of all our goodwill annually as prescribed by ASC 350. The fair value of our reporting units is based on a blend of estimated discounted cash flows, publicly traded company multiples and acquisition multiples. The results from each of these models are then weighted and combined into a single estimate of fair value for our one remaining reporting unit. Estimated discounted cash flows are based on projected sales and related cost of sales. Publicly traded company multiples and acquisition multiples are derived from information on traded shares and analysis of recent acquisitions in the marketplace, respectively, for companies with operations similar to ours. The primary assumptions used in these various models include earnings multiples of acquisitions in a comparable industry, future cash flow estimates of each of our reporting units, weighted average cost of capital, working capital and capital expenditure requirements. We have not made any material changes in our impairment assessment methodology during each fiscal year of 2011, 2010 and 2009. We do not believe the estimates used in the analysis are reasonably likely to change materially in the future but we will continue to assess the estimates in the future based on the expectations of the reporting units. Changes in assumptions used in the fair value calculation could result in an estimated reporting unit fair value that is below the carrying value, which may give rise to an impairment of goodwill.

We perform an annual assessment of the recoverability of goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles. Additionally, we assess goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that such carrying values may not be recoverable. Unforeseen events, changes in circumstances and market conditions and material differences in the value of intangible assets due to changes in estimates of future cash flows could negatively affect the fair value of our assets and result in a non-cash impairment charge. Some factors considered important that could trigger an impairment review include the following: significant underperformance relative to expected historical or projected future operating results, significant changes in the manner of our use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business and significant sustained negative industry or economic trends. See Note 6 — Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

63


Table of Contents

As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, our goodwill was $5.2 million. The results of our fiscal year 2011 annual assessment of the recoverability of goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles indicated that the fair value of the Company’s one remaining reporting unit was in excess of the carrying value of that reporting unit, including goodwill, and thus no impairment existed in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011. In fiscal 2011, our one remaining reporting unit’s fair value would have had to have been lower by more than 30% compared to the fair value estimated in our impairment analysis before its carrying value would exceed the fair value of the reporting unit, indicating that goodwill was potentially impaired.

Allowance for doubtful accounts. Our allowance for doubtful accounts reflects reserves for customer receivables to reduce receivables to amounts expected to be collected. Management uses significant judgment in estimating uncollectible amounts. In estimating uncollectible accounts, management considers factors such as current overall economic conditions, industry-specific economic conditions, historical customer performance and anticipated customer performance. While we believe these processes effectively address our exposure for doubtful accounts and credit losses have historically been within expectations, changes in the economy, industry, or specific customer conditions may require adjustments to the allowance for doubtful accounts. During fiscal years 2011, 2010 and 2009, we established new reserves for doubtful accounts of $1.8 million, $0.1 million and $1.2 million, respectively. Additionally, in each of the three fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, we wrote off uncollectible accounts of $1.0 million, $3.9 million and $2.5 million, respectively, all of which had been previously reserved.

Inventory valuation. In determining the valuation of inventory, we record an allowance for obsolete inventory using the specific identification method for steel coils and other raw materials. Management also reviews the carrying value of inventory for lower of cost or market. Our primary raw material is steel coils which have historically shown significant price volatility. We generally manufacture to customers’ orders, and thus maintain raw materials with a variety of ultimate end uses. We record a lower of cost or market charge to cost of sales when the net realizable value (selling price less estimated cost of disposal), based on our intended end usage, is below our estimated product cost at completion. Estimated net realizable value is based upon assumptions of targeted inventory turn rates, future demand, anticipated finished goods sales prices, management strategy and market conditions for steel. If projected end usage or projected sales prices change significantly from management’s current estimates or actual market conditions are less favorable than those projected by management, inventory write-downs may be required.

Steel prices have recently experienced an unusual level of volatility. As a result, we adjusted our raw material inventory to the lower of cost or market in fiscal 2009 because this inventory exceeded our current estimates of net realizable value less normal profit margins. At November 1, 2009, all inventory with a lower of cost or market adjustment was fully utilized.

Property, plant and equipment valuation. We assess the recoverability of the carrying amount of property, plant and equipment for assets held and used at the lowest level asset grouping for which cash flows can be separately identified, which may be at an individual asset level, plant level or divisional level depending on the intended use of the related asset, if certain events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of such assets may not be recoverable and the undiscounted cash flows estimated to be generated by those assets are less than the carrying amount of those assets. Events and circumstances which indicate an impairment include (a) a significant decrease in the market value of the assets; (b) a significant change in the extent or manner in which an asset is being used or in its physical condition; (c) a significant change in our business conditions; (d) an accumulation of costs significantly in excess of the amount originally expected for the acquisition or construction of an asset; (e) a current-period operating or cash flow loss combined with a history of operating or cash flow losses or a projection that demonstrates continuing losses associated with the use of an asset; or (f) a current expectation that, more likely than not, an asset will be sold or otherwise disposed of significantly before the end of its previously estimated useful life. We assess our assets for impairment on a quarterly basis.

If we determine that the carrying value of an asset is not recoverable based on expected undiscounted future cash flows, excluding interest charges, we record an impairment loss equal to the excess of the carrying amount

 

64


Table of Contents

of the asset over its fair value. The fair value of assets is determined based on prices of similar assets adjusted for their remaining useful life. During fiscal 2009, we adjusted our property, plant and equipment because we determined that the carrying value of certain assets were not recoverable based on expected undiscounted future cash flows. We recorded asset impairments of $1.1 million, $1.1 million and $6.3 million in fiscal 2011, fiscal 2010 and fiscal 2009, respectively. During fiscal 2011 and fiscal 2010, impairments primarily related to facilities classified as held for sale. In determining the impairment for assets held for sale, the fair value of assets was determined based on prices of similar assets in similar condition, adjusted for their remaining useful life.

Contingencies. We establish reserves for estimated loss contingencies when we believe a loss is probable and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. Our contingent liability reserves are related primarily to litigation and environmental matters. Legal costs for uninsured claims are accrued as part of the ultimate settlement. Revisions to contingent liability reserves are reflected in income in the period in which there are changes in facts and circumstances that affect our previous assumptions with respect to the likelihood or amount of loss. Reserves for contingent liabilities are based upon our assumptions and estimates regarding the probable outcome of the matter. We estimate the probable cost by evaluating historical precedent as well as the specific facts relating to each particular contingency (including the opinion of outside advisors, professionals and experts). Should the outcome differ from our assumptions and estimates or other events result in a material adjustment to the accrued estimated reserves, revisions to the estimated reserves for contingent liabilities would be required and would be recognized in the period the new information becomes known.

Beneficial conversion features and dividend policy. Our Convertible Preferred Stock contains beneficial conversion features. In fiscal 2011, we recorded a net $9.4 million beneficial conversion feature charge related to dividends that have accrued and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. We recorded a beneficial conversion feature charge in the amount of $230.9 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2010 related to the availability of shares of Common Stock into which the CD&R Funds may convert their Preferred Shares. In addition, we recorded an additional $19.4 million beneficial conversion feature charge in fiscal 2010 related to dividends that have accrued and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. We expect to recognize additional beneficial conversion feature charges in the future as paid-in-kind dividends are accrued on the Preferred Shares to the extent the market price of our Common Stock exceeds $6.37. Our policy is to recognize beneficial conversion feature charges on paid-in-kind dividends based on a daily dividend recognition and the daily closing stock price of our Common Stock. We believe this recognition policy is reasonable as our policy matches the legal transfer and conversion rights of the majority shareholder.

At any time prior to the Dividend Rate Reduction Event, if dividends are not declared in cash on the applicable dividend declaration date, the rate at which the dividends are payable will be at least 12% per annum. Prior to the vote of the Dividend Payment Committee, the Company is obligated to the 12% dividend rate. Therefore, we accrue dividends based on the 12% rate and if and when we determine the dividends will be paid at a different rate due to either cash payment on the applicable dividend declaration date or obtaining a waiver, we will record a subsequent benefit of the excess 4% accrual upon our board’s declaration of a cash dividend and reverse the beneficial conversion feature charge associated with such accrual.

RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820) (“ASU 2011-04”). The amendments to this update provide a uniform framework for applying the principles of fair value measurement and include (i) amendments that clarify the Board’s intent about the application of existing fair value measurement and disclosure requirements and (ii) amendments that change a particular principle or requirement for measuring fair value or for disclosing information about fair value measurements. These amendments do not require additional fair value measurements. We will adopt ASU 2011-04 in our second fiscal quarter ended April 29, 2012. We do not believe the adoption of ASU 2011-04 will have a material impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

65


Table of Contents

In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) (“ASU 2011-05”), which amends its guidance on the presentation of comprehensive income to increase the prominence of items reported in other comprehensive income. The new guidance requires that all components of comprehensive income in stockholders’ equity be presented either in a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. This amendment is to be applied retrospectively. We will adopt ASU 2011-05 in our first quarter of fiscal 2013 and its adoption will not have any impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-08, Intangibles - Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Testing Goodwill for Impairment (“ASU 2011-08”), which gives companies the option to perform a qualitative assessment to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount and, in some cases, by-pass the two-step impairment test. Early adoption is permitted. Therefore, we will adopt this ASU in our fiscal year ended October 28, 2012. We do not believe the adoption of ASU 2011-08 will have a material impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.

Steel Prices

We are subject to market risk exposure related to volatility in the price of steel. For the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011, steel constituted approximately 72% of our cost of sales. Our business is heavily dependent on the price and supply of steel. Our various products are fabricated from steel produced by mills to forms including bars, plates, structural shapes, sheets, hot-rolled coils and galvanized or Galvalume®-coated coils. The steel industry is highly cyclical in nature, and steel prices have been volatile in recent years and may remain volatile in the future. Steel prices are influenced by numerous factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions domestically and internationally, the availability of raw materials, competition, labor costs, freight and transportation costs, production costs, import duties and other trade restrictions. Given the level of steel industry consolidation, the anticipated additional domestic market capacity from new entrants, generally low inventories in the industry and slow economic recovery, we believe steel prices will continue to be volatile and will be slightly higher, on average, in fiscal 2012 as compared with the prices we experienced during fiscal 2011.

Although we have the ability to purchase steel from a number of suppliers, a production cutback by one or more of our current suppliers could create challenges in meeting delivery schedules to our customers. Because we have periodically adjusted our contract prices, particularly in the engineered building systems segment, we have generally been able to pass increases in our raw material costs through to our customers. The graph below shows the monthly CRU Index data for the North American Steel Price Index over the historical five-year period. The CRU North American Steel Price Index has been published by the CRU Group since 1994 and we believe this index appropriately depicts the volatility of steel prices. The index, based on a CRU survey of industry participants, is now commonly used in the settlement of physical and financial contracts in the steel industry. The prices surveyed are purchases for forward delivery, according to lead time, which will vary. For example, the October index would likely approximate our fiscal December or January steel purchase deliveries based on current lead-times. The volatility in this steel price index is comparable to the volatility we experienced in our average cost of steel. Further, due to the market conditions described above, the most recent CRU prices have been based on a lower than normal trading volume.

 

66


Table of Contents

LOGO

Source: www.crugroup.com

We do not have any long-term contracts for the purchase of steel and normally do not maintain an inventory of steel in excess of our current production requirements. However, from time to time, we may purchase steel in advance of announced steel price increases. We can give no assurance that steel will remain available or that prices will not continue to be volatile.

We rely on a few major suppliers for our supply of steel and may be adversely affected by bankruptcy, change in control, financial condition or other factors affecting those suppliers. During fiscal 2011, we purchased approximately 33% of our steel requirements from two vendors in the United States. No other vendor accounted for over 10% of our steel requirements during fiscal 2011. Due to unfavorable market conditions and our inventory supply requirements, during fiscal 2011, we purchased insignificant amounts of steel from foreign suppliers. Limiting purchases to domestic suppliers further reduces our available steel supply base.

With steel accounting for approximately 72% of our cost of sales for fiscal 2011, a one percent change in the cost of steel would have resulted in a pre-tax impact on cost of sales of approximately $5.5 million for our fiscal year ended October 30, 2011, if such costs were not passed on to our customers. The impact to our financial results of operations would be significantly dependent on the competitive environment and the costs of other alternative building products, which could impact our ability to pass on these higher costs.

Interest Rates

We are subject to market risk exposure related to changes in interest rates on our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility. These instruments bear interest at an agreed upon percentage point spread from either the prime interest rate or LIBOR. Under our Amended Credit Agreement, we may, at our option, fix the interest rate for certain borrowings based on a spread over LIBOR for 30 days to six months. At October 30, 2011, we had $130.7 million outstanding under our senior Amended Credit Agreement. Based on this balance, an immediate change of one percent in the interest rate would cause a change in interest expense of approximately $1.3 million on an annual basis. The fair value of our Amended Credit Agreement at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010 was approximately $127.1 million and $132.0 million, respectively, compared to the face value of $130.7 million and $136.3 million, respectively.

 

67


Table of Contents

See Note 11 — Long-term Debt and Note Payable to the Consolidated Financial Statements for more information on the material terms of our long-term debt.

The table below presents scheduled debt maturities and related weighted-average interest rates for each of the fiscal years relating to debt obligations as of October 30, 2011. Weighted-average variable rates are based on LIBOR rates with a 2% LIBOR floor at October 30, 2011, plus applicable margins.

 

     Scheduled Maturity Date(a)     Fair
Value
 
     2012     2013     2014     2015      2016      Thereafter      Total     10/30/11  
     (In millions, except interest rate percentages)  

Total Debt:

                   

Fixed Rate

   $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —        $ —     

Interest Rate

     —          —          —          —           —           —           —       

Variable Rate

   $ —        $ —        $ 130.7        —         $ —         $ —         $ 130.7      $ 127.1 (b) 

Average interest rate

     8.0     8.0     8.0     —           —           —           8.0  

 

(a) Expected maturity date amounts are based on the face value of debt and do not reflect fair market value of the debt.
(b) Based on recent trading activities of comparable market instruments.

Foreign Currency Exchange Rates

We are exposed to the effect of exchange rate fluctuations on the U.S. dollar value of foreign currency denominated operating revenue and expenses. The functional currency for our Mexico operations is the U.S. dollar. Adjustments resulting from the re-measurement of the local currency financial statements into the U.S. dollar functional currency, which uses a combination of current and historical exchange rates, are included in net income in the current period. Net foreign currency re-measurement gains (losses) were $(0.4) million for the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011 and was immaterial for the fiscal years ended October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009.

The functional currency for our Canadian operations is the Canadian dollar. Translation adjustments resulting from translating the functional currency financial statements into U.S. dollar equivalents are reported separately in accumulated other comprehensive income in stockholders’ equity. The net foreign currency gains (losses) included in net income for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009 was $(0.1) million, $0.5 million and $0.4 million, respectively. Net foreign currency translation adjustment, net of tax, and included in other comprehensive income was immaterial for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010.

 

68


Table of Contents
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

     70   

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

     71   

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     72   

Financial Statements:

  

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Fiscal Years Ended October 30, 2011, October  31, 2010 and November 1, 2009

     73   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010

     74   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Fiscal Years Ended October 30, 2011, October  31, 2010 and November 1, 2009

     75   

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity (Deficit) for the Fiscal Years Ended October  30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009

     76   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss for the Fiscal Years Ended October  30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009

     77   

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

     78   

 

69


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

Management of NCI Building Systems, Inc. (the “Company” or “our”) is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. The Company’s internal control system was designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and board of directors regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

Internal control over financial reporting includes the controls themselves, monitoring (including internal auditing practices), and actions taken to correct deficiencies as identified.

Internal control over financial reporting has inherent limitations and may not prevent or detect misstatements. The design of an internal control system is also based in part upon assumptions and judgments made by management about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no assurance that an internal control will be effective under all potential future conditions. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance with respect to the financial statement preparation and presentation. Further, because of changes in conditions, the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting may vary over time.

Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of October 30, 2011. In making this assessment, management used the criteria for internal control over financial reporting described in Internal Control — Integrated Framework by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). Management’s assessment included an evaluation of the design of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting and testing of the operating effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting. Management reviewed the results of its assessment with the Audit Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors. Based on this assessment, management has concluded that, as of October 30, 2011, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective.

Ernst & Young LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that has audited the Company’s consolidated financial statements, has audited the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of October 30, 2011. Their report included elsewhere herein expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of October 30, 2011.

 

70


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

The Board of Directors and Shareholders of NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries

We have audited NCI Building Systems, Inc.’s and subsidiaries (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of October 30, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of October 30, 2011, based on the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries as of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity (deficit), cash flows and comprehensive loss for each of the three years in the period ended October 30, 2011 of NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries and our report dated December 21, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Houston, Texas

December 21, 2011

 

71


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

The Board of Directors and Shareholders of NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity (deficit), cash flows and comprehensive loss for each of the three years in the period ended October 30, 2011. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended October 30, 2011, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), NCI Building Systems, Inc. and subsidiaries internal control over financial reporting as of October 30, 2011, based on the criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated December 21, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Houston, Texas

December 21, 2011

 

72


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 
     (In thousands, except per share data)  

Sales

   $ 959,577      $ 870,526      $ 965,252   

Cost of sales, excluding lower of cost or market adjustment and asset impairments, net

     758,023        699,641        748,756   

Lower of cost or market adjustment

     —          —          39,986   

Asset impairments, net

     1,121        1,070        6,291   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     200,433        169,815        170,219   

Engineering, selling, general and administrative expenses

     202,352        190,870        210,753   

Goodwill and other intangible asset impairments

     —          —          622,564   

Restructuring charges (recovery)

     (292     3,532        9,052   

Change of control charges

     —          —          11,168   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (1,627     (24,587     (683,318

Interest income

     127        91        393   

Interest expense

     (15,723     (17,918     (29,249

Debt extinguishment and refinancing costs, net

     —          76        (97,580

Other income, net

     876        2,131        2,045   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (16,347     (40,207     (807,709

Benefit from income taxes

     (6,397     (13,330     (56,913
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (9,950   $ (26,877   $ (750,796

Convertible preferred stock dividends and accretion

     28,120        34,055        1,187   

Convertible preferred stock beneficial conversion feature

     9,396        250,295        10,526   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss applicable to common shares

   $ (47,466   $ (311,227   $ (762,509
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss per common share:

      

Basic

   $ (2.58   $ (17.07   $ (171.18
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ (2.58   $ (17.07   $ (171.18
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding:

      

Basic

     18,369        18,229        4,403   

Diluted

     18,369        18,229        4,403   

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

 

73


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 
     (In thousands,  
   except share data)  
ASSETS   

Current assets:

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 78,982      $ 77,419   

Restricted cash

     2,836        2,839   

Accounts receivable, net

     95,381        81,896   

Inventories, net

     88,531        81,386   

Deferred income taxes

     20,405        15,101   

Income tax receivable

     1,272        15,919   

Investments in debt and equity securities, at market

     4,483        3,738   

Prepaid expenses and other

     14,847        13,923   

Assets held for sale

     4,874        6,114   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     311,611        298,335   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

     208,514        214,453   

Goodwill

     5,200        5,200   

Intangible assets, net

     24,254        26,312   

Other assets, net

     11,575        16,224   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 561,154      $ 560,524   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ DEFICIT     

Current liabilities:

    

Note payable

   $ 292      $ 289   

Accounts payable

     88,158        70,589   

Accrued compensation and benefits

     34,616        31,731   

Accrued interest

     1,309        1,546   

Other accrued expenses

     49,668        46,723   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     174,043        150,878   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt

     130,699        136,305   

Deferred income taxes

     7,312        10,947   

Other long-term liabilities

     10,081        4,820   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long-term liabilities

     148,092        152,072   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Series B cumulative convertible participating preferred stock

     273,950        256,870   

Redeemable common stock

     759        3,418   

Common stock, $.01 par value, 100,000,000 shares authorized; 19,954,323 and 19,259,423 shares issued in 2011 and 2010, respectively; and 19,829,898 and 19,259,423 shares outstanding in 2011 and 2010, respectively

     924        921   

Additional paid-in capital

     237,244        255,248   

Accumulated deficit

     (266,896     (256,946

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (5,485     (1,937

Treasury stock, at cost (124,425 shares in 2011)

     (1,477     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ deficit

     (35,690     (2,714
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ deficit

   $ 561,154      $ 560,524   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

 

74


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 
     (In thousands)  

Cash flows from operating activities:

      

Net loss

   $ (9,950   $ (26,877   $ (750,796

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities:

      

Depreciation and amortization

     33,214        34,504        33,531   

Non-cash interest expense on Convertible Notes

     —          —          8,394   

Share-based compensation expense

     6,908        4,953        4,835   

Accelerated vesting of share-based compensation

     —          —          9,066   

Debt extinguishment and refinancing costs, net

     —          (76     91,937   

Gain on embedded derivative

     (25     (937     —     

(Gain) loss on sale of property, plant and equipment

     50        180        (928

Lower of cost or market reserve

     —          —          39,986   

Provision for doubtful accounts

     1,844        78        1,221   

Interest rate swap ineffectiveness

     —          —          3,072   

Provision (benefit) for deferred income taxes

     (6,397     43        (26,841

Asset impairments, net

     1,121        1,070        6,291   

Impairment of goodwill and intangible assets

     —          —          622,564   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of effect of acquisitions:

      

Accounts receivable

     (15,329     915        78,895   

Inventories

     (7,145     (9,849     79,362   

Income tax receivable

     14,382        12,434        (32,332

Prepaid expenses and other

     (247     1,736        (1,423

Accounts payable

     17,569        150        (30,754

Accrued expenses

     5,668        (12,975     (41,599

Other, net

     (226     957        855   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities:

     41,437        6,306        95,336   

Cash flows from investing activities:

      

Capital expenditures

     (21,040     (14,030     (21,657

Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment

     583        767        2,589   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities:

     (20,457     (13,263     (19,068

Cash flows from financing activities:

      

Proceeds from stock options exercised

     —          —          12   

Decrease (increase) of restricted cash

     3        10,140        (12,979

Excess tax benefits from share-based compensation arrangements

     464        —          —     

Proceeds from ABL facility

     43        245        —     

Payments on ABL facility

     (43     (246     —     

Payments on term loan

     (5,250     (13,695     (143,300

Payments on other long-term debt

     (355     (190     (910

Payments on note payable

     (1,543     (1,724     (1,693

Issuance of convertible preferred stock

     —          —          250,000   

Payment of cash dividends on convertible preferred stock

     (11,039     —          —     

Payment of convertible notes

     —          (59     (89,971

Payment of refinancing costs

     (200     (125     (54,659

Purchase of treasury stock

     (1,477     (381     (451
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in financing activities:

     (19,397     (6,035     (53,951

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     (20     (8     (99

Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents

     1,563        (13,000     22,218   

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

     77,419        90,419        68,201   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

   $ 78,982      $ 77,419      $ 90,419   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

 

75


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.

 

   

 

Common Stock

    Additional
Paid-In
Capital
    Retained
Earnings
(Deficit)
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
(Loss) Income
    Treasury Stock     Stockholders’
Equity (Deficit)
 
    Shares     Amount           Shares     Amount    
    (In thousands, except share data)  

Balance, November 2, 2008

    4,480,742      $ 224      $ 225,153      $ 520,736      $ (1,440     (533,937   $ (116,599   $ 628,074   

Treasury stock purchases

    —          —          —          —          —          (35,384     (451     (451

Retirement of treasury shares

    (569,321     (29     (117,021     —          —          569,321        117,050        —     

Common stock issued for stock option exercises

    165        —          12        —          —          —          —          12   

Tax benefit from employee stock incentive plan

    —          —          (5,073     —          —          —          —          (5,073

Convertible Notes exchange

    14,035,417        702        169,725        —          —          —          —          170,427   

Convertible Preferred Stock dividends payable

    —          —          (1,187     —          —          —          —          (1,187

Tax benefit from Convertible Preferred Stock

    —          —          2,585        —          —          —          —          2,585   

Issuance of restricted stock

    135,026        7        (3     —          —          —          —          4   

Other comprehensive loss

    —          —          —          —          (7,419     —          —          (7,419

Share-based compensation

    —          —          13,902        —          —          —          —          13,902   

Net loss

    —          —          —          (750,796     —          —          —          (750,796
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, November 1, 2009

    18,082,029      $ 904      $ 288,093      $ (230,060   $ (8,859     —        $ —        $ 50,078   

Redeemable common stock (Note 13)

    (304,864     (3     (3,578     (9     —          —          —          (3,590

Treasury stock purchases

    —          —          —          —          —          (356     (381     (381

Retirement of treasury shares

    (356     —          (381     —          —          356        381        —     

Other transaction costs

    —          —          216        —          —          —          —          216   

Convertible Preferred Stock dividends and accretion

    —          —          (34,055     —          —          —          —          (34,055

Issuance of restricted stock

    1,482,614        20        —          —          —          —          —          20   

Other comprehensive income

    —          —          —          —          6,922        —          —          6,922   

Share-based compensation

    —          —          4,953        —          —          —          —          4,953   

Net loss

    —          —          —          (26,877     —          —          —          (26,877
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, October 31, 2010

    19,259,423      $ 921      $ 255,248      $ (256,946   $ (1,937     —        $ —        $ (2,714

Redeemable common stock (Note 13)

    243,033        —          2,744        —          —          —          —          2,744   

Treasury stock purchases

    —          —          —          —          —          (124,425     (1,477     (1,477

Other transaction costs

    —          —          464        —          —          —          —          464   

Convertible Preferred Stock dividends and accretion

    —          —          (28,120     —          —          —          —          (28,120

Issuance of restricted stock

    451,867        3        —          —          —          —          —          3   

Other comprehensive income

    —          —          —          —          (3,548     —          —          (3,548

Share-based compensation

    —          —          6,908        —          —          —          —          6,908   

Net loss

    —          —          —          (9,950     —          —          —          (9,950
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, October 30, 2011

    19,954,323      $ 924      $ 237,244      $ (266,896   $ (5,485     (124,425   $ (1,477   $ (35,690
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

 

76


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 
     (In thousands)  

Comprehensive loss:

      

Net loss

   $ (9,950   $ (26,877   $ (750,796

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

      

Foreign exchange translation gain (loss) and other (net of income tax of $0 in 2011, $0 in 2010 and $107 in 2009)

     (19     196        (198

Unrecognized actuarial gain (loss) on pension obligation (net of income tax of $2,202 in 2011, $(4,493) in 2010 and $6,010 in 2009)

     (3,534     6,726        (9,641

Loss in fair value of interest rate swap (net of income tax of $345 in 2009)

     —          —          (554

Gains in value of foreign currency derivative (net of income tax of $(37) in 2011)

     5        —          —     

Reclassification adjustment for losses on derivative instruments recognized during the period (net of income tax of $1,854 in 2009)

     —          —          2,974   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

     (3,548     6,922        (7,419
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive loss

   $ (13,498   $ (19,955   $ (758,215
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

 

77


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.

1. NATURE OF BUSINESS AND PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION

NCI Building Systems, Inc. (together with its subsidiaries, unless otherwise indicated, the “Company,” “we,” “us” or “our”) is North America’s largest integrated manufacturer and marketer of metal products for the nonresidential construction industry. We provide metal coil coating services and design, engineer, manufacture and market metal components and engineered building systems primarily used in nonresidential construction. We manufacture and distribute extensive lines of metal products for the nonresidential construction market under multiple brand names through a nationwide network of plants and distribution centers. We sell our products for both new construction and repair and retrofit applications.

On October 20, 2009 the Company issued and sold to Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. and CD&R Friends & Family Fund VIII, L.P. (together, the “CD&R Funds”), an aggregate of 250,000 shares of a newly created class of convertible preferred stock, par value $1.00 per share, of the Company, designated the Series B Cumulative Convertible Participating Preferred Stock (the “Convertible Preferred Stock,” and shares thereof, the “Preferred Shares”), initially representing approximately 68.4% of the voting power and common stock of the Company on an as-converted basis (such purchase and sale, the “Equity Investment”). As of October 30, 2011, the Convertible Preferred Stock, including accrued but unpaid dividends, represented 70.1% of the voting power and Common Stock of the Company on an as-converted basis.

On March 5, 2010, the Company effected a reverse stock split in which each five shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.01 (the “Common Stock” and shares thereof, the “Common Shares”), was reclassified and combined into one share of Common Stock (the “Reverse Stock Split”). As such, we have retrospectively adjusted basic and diluted earnings per common share, Common Stock, stock options, Common Stock equivalents and prices per share information for the Reverse Stock Split in all periods presented.

We use a 52/53 week year with our fiscal year end on the Sunday closest to October 31. The year end for fiscal 2011 is October 30, 2011.

We aggregate our operations into three reportable business segments: metal coil coating, metal components and engineered building systems. We base this aggregation on similarities in product lines, manufacturing processes, marketing and how we manage our business. We market the products in each of our business segments nationwide through a direct sales force and, in the case of our engineered building systems segment, through authorized builder networks.

Our Consolidated Financial Statements include the accounts of the Company and all majority-owned subsidiaries. All intercompany accounts, transactions and profits arising from consolidated entities have been eliminated in consolidation.

2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

(a) Use of Estimates. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Examples include provisions for bad debts and inventory reserves and accruals for employee benefits, general liability insurance, warranties and certain contingencies. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

(b) Cash and Cash Equivalents. Cash equivalents are stated at cost plus accrued interest, which approximates fair value. Cash equivalents are highly liquid debt instruments with an original maturity of three

 

78


Table of Contents

months or less and may consist of time deposits with a number of commercial banks with high credit ratings, Eurodollar time deposits, money market instruments, certificates of deposit and commercial paper. Our policy allows us to also invest excess funds in no-load, open-end, management investment trusts (“mutual funds”). The mutual funds invest exclusively in high quality money market instruments. As of October 30, 2011, our cash equivalents were all invested in money market instruments.

(c) Accounts Receivable and Related Allowance. We report accounts receivable net of the allowance for doubtful accounts. Trade accounts receivable are the result of sales of building systems, components and coating services to customers throughout the United States and affiliated territories, including international builders who resell to end users. Substantially all sales are denominated in U.S. dollars with the exception of sales at our Canadian operations which are denominated in Canadian dollars. Credit sales do not normally require a pledge of collateral; however, various types of liens may be filed to enhance the collection process.

We establish reserves for doubtful accounts on a customer by customer basis when we believe the required payment of specific amounts owed is unlikely to occur. In establishing these reserves, we consider changes in the financial position of a customer, availability of security, lien rights and bond rights as well as disputes, if any, with our customers. Our allowance for doubtful accounts reflects reserves for customer receivables to reduce receivables to amounts expected to be collected. We determine past due status as of the contractual payment date. Interest on delinquent accounts receivable is included in the trade accounts receivable balance and recognized as interest income when earned and collectability is reasonably assured. Uncollectible accounts are written off when a settlement is reached for an amount that is less than the outstanding historical balance or we have exhausted all collection efforts. The following table represents the rollforward of our uncollectible accounts and backcharge activity for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009 (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 

Beginning balance

   $ 5,232      $ 9,039      $ 10,330   

Provision for bad debts

     1,843        78        1,221   

Amounts charged against allowance for bad debts, net of recoveries

     (966     (3,885     (2,512
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 6,109      $ 5,232      $ 9,039   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(d) Inventories. Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market value less allowance for inventory obsolescence, using specific identification or the weighted-average method for steel coils and other raw materials. During fiscal 2009, we incurred lower of cost or market adjustments of $8.1 million in the metal coil coating segment, $17.2 million in the metal components segment and $14.7 million in the engineered building systems segment for a total of $40.0 million. Lower of cost or market adjustments were recorded because this inventory exceeded our estimated net realizable value less normal profit margins. All inventory with a lower of cost or market adjustment was fully utilized by July 2009.

The components of inventory are as follows (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
     October 31,
2010
 

Raw materials

   $ 62,801       $ 56,834   

Work in process and finished goods

     25,730         24,552   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 88,531       $ 81,386   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

79


Table of Contents

The following table represents the rollforward of reserve for obsolete materials and supplies activity for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009 (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 

Beginning balance

   $ 1,231      $ 1,592      $ 1,807   

Provisions

     732        639        1,409   

Dispositions

     (614     (1,000     (1,624
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 1,349      $ 1,231      $ 1,592   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

During fiscal 2011, we purchased approximately 33% of our steel requirements from two vendors in the United States. No other vendor accounted for over 10% of our steel requirements during fiscal 2011.

(e) Assets Held for Sale. We record assets held for sale at the lower of the carrying value or fair value less costs to sell. The following criteria are used to determine if property is held for sale: (i) management has the authority and commits to a plan to sell the property; (iii) the property is available for immediate sale in its present condition; (iii) there is an active program to locate a buyer and the plan to sell the property has been initiated; (iv) the sale of the property is probable within one year; (v) the property is being actively marketed at a reasonable sale price relative to its current fair value; and (vi) it is unlikely that the plan to sell will be withdrawn or that significant changes to the plan will be made.

In determining the fair value of the assets less cost to sell, we considered factors including current sales prices for comparable assets in the area, recent market analysis studies, appraisals and any recent legitimate offers. If the estimated fair value less cost to sell of an asset is less than its current carrying value, the asset is written down to its estimated fair value less cost to sell. During fiscal 2011, we recorded impairments on assets held for sale of $1.0 million.

Due to uncertainties in the estimation process, it is reasonably possible that actual results could differ from the estimates used in our historical analyses. Our assumptions about property sales prices require significant judgment because the current market is highly sensitive to changes in economic conditions. We calculated the estimated fair values of assets held for sale based on current market conditions and assumptions made by management, which may differ materially from actual results and may result in additional impairments if market conditions continue to deteriorate.

(f) Property, Plant and Equipment and Leases. Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost and depreciated using the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives. Leasehold improvements are capitalized and amortized using the straight-line method over the shorter of their estimated useful lives or the term of the underlying lease. Computer software developed or purchased for internal use is depreciated using the straight-line method over its estimated useful life. Depreciation and amortization are recognized in cost of sales and engineering, selling, general and administrative expenses based on the nature and use of the underlying asset(s). Operating leases are expensed using the straight-line method over the term of the underlying lease.

Depreciation expense for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $26.3 million, $27.7 million and $29.9 million, respectively. Of this depreciation expense, $6.3 million, $6.3 million and $7.1 million was related to software depreciation for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

80


Table of Contents

Property, plant and equipment consists of the following (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Land

   $ 22,234      $ 22,368   

Buildings and improvements

     168,660        168,126   

Machinery, equipment and furniture

     205,108        207,013   

Transportation equipment

     2,939        3,023   

Computer software and equipment

     79,250        77,482   

Construction in progress

     27,614        16,028   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     505,805        494,040   

Less accumulated depreciation

     (297,291     (279,587
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 208,514      $ 214,453   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Estimated useful lives for depreciation are:

 

Buildings and improvements

     10 — 39 years   

Machinery, equipment and furniture

     3 — 10 years   

Transportation equipment

     5 — 10 years   

Computer software and equipment

     3 —   7 years   

We capitalize interest on capital invested in projects in accordance with ASC Topic 835, Interest. For each of fiscal 2011 and 2009, the total amount of interest capitalized was 0.7 million. For fiscal 2010, the total amount of interest capitalized was immaterial. Upon commencement of operations, capitalized interest, as a component of the total cost of the asset, is amortized over the estimated useful life of the asset.

(g) Internally Developed Software. Internally developed software is stated at cost less accumulated amortization and is amortized using the straight-line method over its estimated useful life ranging from 3 to 7 years. Certain internally developed software in the amount of $2.6 million and included in construction in progress is currently on-hold but management believes it is probable the software will be completed and implemented in the foreseeable future. Software assets are reviewed for impairment when events or circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable over the remaining lives of the assets. During the software application development stage, capitalized costs include external consulting costs, cost of software licenses and internal payroll and payroll related costs for employees who are directly associated with a software project. Upgrades and enhancements are capitalized if they result in added functionality which enable the software to perform tasks it was previously incapable of performing. Software maintenance, training, data conversion and business process reengineering costs are expensed in the period in which they are incurred.

(h) Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets. We review the carrying values of goodwill and identifiable intangibles whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that such carrying values may not be recoverable and annually for goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets as required by ASC Topic 350, Intangibles — Goodwill and Other. Unforeseen events, changes in circumstances, market conditions and material differences in the value of intangible assets due to changes in estimates of future cash flows could negatively affect the fair value of our assets and result in a non-cash impairment charge. Some factors considered important that could trigger an impairment review include the following: significant underperformance relative to expected historical or projected future operating results, significant changes in the manner of our use of acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business and significant negative industry or economic trends.

(i) Revenue Recognition. We recognize revenues when the following conditions are met: persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has occurred or services have been rendered, the price is fixed or determinable, and collectability is reasonably assured. Generally, these criteria are met at the time product is shipped or services are complete. Provisions are made upon sale for estimated product returns.

 

81


Table of Contents

(j) Equity Raising and Deferred Financing Costs. Equity raising costs are recorded as a reduction to additional paid in capital upon the execution of an equity transaction. In connection with the Exchange Offer on the Convertible Notes, we incurred $5.7 million in equity raising costs. Deferred financing costs are capitalized as incurred and amortized using the effective interest method over the expected life of the debt. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the unamortized balance in deferred financing costs was $11.6 million and $16.2 million, respectively.

Costs related to potential pre-packaged bankruptcy related to our 2009 financial restructuring were expensed as incurred. During fiscal 2009, we expensed $4.8 million of pre-packaged bankruptcy costs which were included in debt extinguishment and refinancing costs in our Consolidated Statement of Operations. All potential pre-packaged bankruptcy costs were incurred in connection with the Recapitalization Plan and were expensed in fiscal 2009.

(k) Cost of sales. Cost of sales includes the cost of inventory sold during the period, including costs for manufacturing, inbound freight, receiving, inspection, warehousing, and internal transfers less vendor rebates. Costs associated with shipping and handling our products are included in cost of sales. Cost of sales is exclusive of lower of cost or market adjustments and asset impairments because these items are shown below cost of sales on our Consolidated Statement of Operations. Purchasing costs and engineering and drafting costs are included in engineering, selling, general and administrative expense. Purchasing costs were $2.7 million, $2.5 million and $3.2 million and engineering and drafting costs were $40.2 million, $39.6 million and $38.2 million in each of fiscal 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively. Approximately $2.0 million and $1.7 million of these engineering, selling, general and administrative costs were capitalized and remained in inventory at the end of fiscal 2011 and 2010, respectively.

(l) Warranty. We sell weathertightness warranties to our customers for protection from leaks in our roofing systems related to weather. These warranties range from two years to 20 years. We sell two types of warranties, standard and Single Sourcetm, and three grades of coverage for each. The type and grade of coverage determines the price to the customer. For standard warranties, our responsibility for leaks in a roofing system begins after 24 consecutive leak-free months. For Single Sourcetm warranties, the roofing system must pass our inspection before warranty coverage will be issued. Inspections are typically performed at three stages of the roofing project: (i) at the project start-up; (ii) at the project mid-point; and (iii) at the project completion. These inspections are included in the cost of the warranty. If the project requires or the customer requests additional inspections, those inspections are billed to the customer. Upon the sale of a warranty, we record the resulting revenue as deferred revenue, which is included in other accrued expenses in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. We recognize deferred warranty revenue over the warranty coverage period in a manner that matches our estimated expenses relating to the warranty. Additionally, we maintain an accrued warranty at Robertson-Ceco II Corporation (“RCC”) in which the balance was $3.1 million at October 30, 2011. RCC’s accrued warranty programs have similar terms and characteristics to our other warranty programs although this warranty is not amortized in the same manner as our other warranty programs. See Note 10 — Warranty.

(m) Insurance. Group medical insurance is purchased through Blue Cross Blue Shield (“BCBS”). The plans include a Preferred Provider Organization (“PPO”) plan and an Exclusive Provider Organization (“EPO”) plan. These plans are managed-care plans utilizing networks to achieve discounts through negotiated rates with the providers within these networks. The claims incurred under these plans are self-funded for the first $250,000 of each claim. We purchase individual stop loss reinsurance to limit our claims liability to $250,000 per claim. BCBS administers all claims, including claims processing, utilization review and network access charges.

Insurance is purchased for workers compensation and employer liability, general liability, property and auto liability/auto physical damage. We utilize either deductibles or self-insurance retentions (“SIR”) to limit our exposure to catastrophic loss. The workers compensation insurance has a $500,000 per-occurrence deductible. The property and auto liability insurances have per-occurrence deductibles of $50,000 and $250,000,

 

82


Table of Contents

respectively. The general liability insurance has a $350,000 SIR. Umbrella insurance coverage is purchased to protect us against claims that exceed our per-occurrence or aggregate limits set forth in our respective policies. All claims are adjusted utilizing a third-party claims administrator and insurance carrier claims adjusters.

Each reporting period, we record the costs of our health insurance plan, including paid claims, an estimate of the change in incurred but not reported (“IBNR”) claims, taxes and administrative fees, when applicable, (collectively the “Plan Costs”) as general and administrative expenses in our Consolidated Statements of Operations. The estimated IBNR claims are based upon (i) a recent average level of paid claims under the plan, (ii) an estimated lag factor and (iii) an estimated growth factor to provide for those claims that have been incurred but not yet reported and paid. We use an independent actuary to determine the claims lag and estimated liability for IBNR claims.

For workers’ compensation costs, we monitor the number of accidents and the severity of such accidents to develop appropriate estimates for expected costs to provide both medical care and indemnity benefits, when applicable, for the period of time that an employee is incapacitated and unable to work. These accruals are developed using independent third-party actuarial estimates of the expected cost for medical treatment, and length of time an employee will be unable to work based on industry statistics for the cost of similar disabilities, to include statutory impairment ratings. For general liability and automobile claims, accruals are developed based on independent third-party actuarial estimates of the expected cost to resolve each claim, including damages and defense costs, based on legal and industry trends and the nature and severity of the claim. Accruals also include estimates for IBNR claims, and taxes and administrative fees, when applicable. Each reporting period, we record the costs of our workers’ compensation, general liability and automobile claims, including paid claims, an estimate of the change in IBNR claims, taxes and administrative fees as general and administrative expenses in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.

(n) Advertising Costs. Advertising costs are expensed as incurred. Advertising expense was $5.0 million, $4.6 million and $5.4 million in fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

(o) Impairment of Long-Lived Assets. We assess impairment of property, plant, and equipment in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 360, Property, Plant, and Equipment. We assess the recoverability of the carrying amount of property, plant and equipment if certain events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of such assets may not be recoverable, such as a significant decrease in market value of the assets or a significant change in our business conditions. If we determine that the carrying value of an asset is not recoverable based on expected undiscounted future cash flows, excluding interest charges, we record an impairment loss equal to the excess of the carrying amount of the asset over its fair value. The fair value of assets is determined based on prices of similar assets adjusted for their remaining useful life. During fiscal 2009, we adjusted our property, plant and equipment because we determined that the carrying value of certain assets were not recoverable based on expected undiscounted future cash flows. We recorded asset impairments of $1.1 million in fiscal 2011, which included $1.0 million related to assets held for sale. During fiscal 2010, we recorded impairments on assets held for sale of $1.2 million. We recorded asset impairments of $6.3 million in fiscal 2009, which included $1.2 million related to assets held for sale. See Note 4 – Plant Restructuring and Asset Impairments for asset impairments in fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009.

(p) Share-Based Compensation. Compensation expense recorded for restricted stock awards under the intrinsic value method is consistent with the expense that is recorded under the fair value-based method. We recorded the recurring pretax compensation expense relating to restricted stock awards and stock options of $6.9 million, $5.0 million and $4.8 million for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The acceleration of the unamortized compensation expense upon the change in control was $9.1 million in fiscal 2009 and was included in change of control charges on the Consolidated Statement of Operations.

(q) Foreign Currency Re-measurement and Translation. In accordance ASC Topic 830, Foreign Currency Matters, the functional currency for our Mexico operations is the U.S. dollar. Adjustments resulting from the

 

83


Table of Contents

re-measurement of the local currency financial statements into the U.S. dollar functional currency, which uses a combination of current and historical exchange rates, are included in net income in the current period. Net foreign currency re-measurement gains (losses) are reflected in income for the period. Net foreign currency re-measurement gains (losses) were $(0.4) million for the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011 and were immaterial for the fiscal years ended October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009.

The functional currency for our Canadian operations is the Canadian dollar. Translation adjustments resulting from translating the functional currency financial statements into U.S. dollar equivalents are reported separately in accumulated other comprehensive income in stockholders’ equity. The net foreign currency gains (losses) included in net income for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009 was $(0.1) million, $0.5 million and $0.4 million. Net foreign currency translation gain (loss), net of tax, and included in other comprehensive income was immaterial for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010.

(r) Contingencies. We establish reserves for estimated loss contingencies and unasserted claims when we believe a loss is probable and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. Our contingent liability reserves are related primarily to litigation and environmental matters. Revisions to contingent liability reserves are reflected in income in the period in which there are changes in facts and circumstances that affect our previous assumptions with respect to the likelihood or amount of loss. Reserves for contingent liabilities are based upon our assumptions and estimates regarding the probable outcome of the matter. We estimate the probable cost by evaluating historical precedent as well as the specific facts relating to each particular contingency (including the opinion of outside advisors, professionals and experts). Should the outcome differ from our assumptions and estimates or other events result in a material adjustment to the accrued estimated reserves, revisions to the estimated reserves for contingent liabilities would be required and would be recognized in the period the new information becomes known.

(s) Beneficial conversion features and dividend policy. Our Convertible Preferred Stock contains beneficial conversion features. We expect to recognize additional beneficial conversion feature charges in the future as paid-in-kind dividends are accrued on the Preferred Shares to the extent the market price of our Common Stock exceeds $6.37. Our policy is to recognize beneficial conversion feature charges on paid-in-kind dividends based on a daily dividend recognition and the daily closing stock price of our Common Stock. We believe this recognition policy is reasonable as our policy matches the legal transfer and conversion rights of the majority shareholder.

At any time prior to the Dividend Rate Reduction Event, if dividends are not declared in cash on the applicable dividend declaration date, the rate at which the dividends are payable will be at least 12% per annum. Prior to the vote of the Dividend Payment Committee, the Company is obligated to the 12% dividend rate. Therefore, we accrue dividends based on the 12% rate and if and when we determine the dividends will be paid at a different rate due to either cash payment on the applicable dividend declaration date or obtaining a waiver, we will record a subsequent benefit of the excess 4% accrual upon our board’s declaration of a cash dividend and reverse the beneficial conversion feature charge associated with such accrual.

(t) Income taxes. The determination of our provision for income taxes requires significant judgment, the use of estimates and the interpretation and application of complex tax laws. Our provision for income taxes reflects a combination of income earned and taxed in the various U.S. federal and state, Canadian federal and provincial as well as Mexican federal jurisdictions. Jurisdictional tax law changes, increases or decreases in permanent differences between book and tax items, accruals or adjustments of accruals for tax contingencies or valuation allowances, and the change in the mix of earnings from these taxing jurisdictions all affect the overall effective tax rate.

In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, we must consider whether it is more likely than not that some portion, or all, of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. We consider all available evidence, both

 

84


Table of Contents

positive and negative, in determining whether a valuation allowance is required. Such evidence includes the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, projected future taxable income and tax planning strategies in making this assessment, and judgment is required in considering the relative weight of negative and positive evidence. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had a full valuation allowance in the amount of $5.4 million and $5.2 million, respectively, on the deferred tax assets of Robertson Building Systems Ltd., our Canadian subsidiary.

We expect to generate sufficient operating profits in future periods to fully utilize the net U.S. deferred tax assets of $14.6 million. In the event our expectations of future operating results change, a valuation allowance may be required on our existing unreserved net U.S. deferred tax assets. Our expectations could change in the near term if nonresidential construction fails to continue its projected recovery.

(u) Reclassifications. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior period amounts in our Consolidated Balance Sheets, Consolidated Statements of Operations and Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements to conform to the current presentation. These reclassifications include the reclassification of shares of our common stock, par value $0.01 (the “Common Stock”), to redeemable common stock. See Note 13 – Redeemable Common Stock. The net effect of these reclassifications was not material to our Consolidated Financial Statements.

3. ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

Adopted Accounting Pronouncements

Defined Benefit Plans Adoption

In December 2008, the FASB issued ASC Subtopic 715-20, Defined Benefit Plans — General (“ASC 715-20”). This statement provides guidance on an employer’s disclosures about plan assets of a defined benefit pension or other postretirement plan. We adopted the disclosure provisions required by ASC 715-20 in fiscal 2010 but are not required to implement the disclosures for earlier periods presented for comparative purposes. See Note 22 — Employee Benefit Plans.

Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Adoption

In January 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-06, Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements. This update amends FASB ASC 820-10-50 to require new disclosures concerning (1) transfers into and out of Levels 1 and 2 of the fair value measurement hierarchy, and (2) activity in Level 3 measurements. In addition, this update clarifies certain existing disclosure requirements regarding the level of disaggregation and inputs and valuation techniques. Finally, this update makes conforming amendments to the guidance on employers’ disclosures about postretirement benefit plan assets. We adopted this update on May 2, 2010, except for the requirement to separately disclose activity in Level 3 measurements which is effective for our fiscal year ended October 28, 2012. With the exception of additional fair value measurement disclosures, the adoption of this update did not have a material impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements. See Note 16 — Fair Value of Financial Instruments and Fair Value Measurements.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820) (“ASU 2011-04”). The amendments to this update provide a uniform framework for applying the principles of fair value measurement and include (i) amendments that clarify the Board’s intent about the application of existing fair value measurement and disclosure requirements and (ii) amendments that change a particular principle or requirement for measuring fair value or for disclosing information about fair value measurements. These amendments do not require additional fair value measurements. We will adopt ASU 2011-04 in our second fiscal quarter ended April 29, 2012. We do not believe the adoption of ASU 2011-04 will have a material impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

85


Table of Contents

In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) (“ASU 2011-05”), which amends its guidance on the presentation of comprehensive income to increase the prominence of items reported in other comprehensive income. The new guidance requires that all components of comprehensive income in stockholders’ equity be presented either in a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. This amendment is to be applied retrospectively. We will adopt ASU 2011-05 in our first quarter of fiscal 2013 and its adoption will not have any impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-08, Intangibles - Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Testing Goodwill for Impairment (“ASU 2011-08”), which gives companies the option to perform a qualitative assessment to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount and, in some cases, by-pass the two-step impairment test. Early adoption is permitted. Therefore, we will adopt this ASU in our fiscal year ended October 28, 2012. We do not believe the adoption of ASU 2011-08 will have a material impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

4. PLANT RESTRUCTURING AND ASSET IMPAIRMENTS

Fiscal 2008 Plan

As a result of the market downturn which began in fiscal 2008, we implemented a phased process to resize and realign our manufacturing operations. The purpose of these activities was to close some of our least efficient facilities and to retool certain of these facilities to allow us to better utilize our assets and expand into new markets or better provide products to our customers, such as insulated panel systems.

In November 2008, we approved the Phase I plan to close three of our engineered building systems manufacturing plants and retool one of these facilities. In addition, as part of the Phase I restructuring, we implemented a general employee reduction program (“General”). In a continuing effort to rationalize our least efficient facilities, in February 2009, we approved the Phase II plan to close one of our facilities within the engineered building systems segment, and in April 2009, we approved the Phase III plan to close or idle three of our manufacturing facilities within the engineered building systems segment and two facilities within the metal components segment. In addition, manufacturing at one of our metal components facilities was temporarily suspended and currently functions as a distribution and customer service site. As part of the Phase III plan, we also increased General.

As a result of actions taken in our restructuring, certain facilities in our engineering building systems and metal components segments are being actively marketed for sale and have been classified as held for sale in the Consolidated Balance Sheet. During fiscal 2011, we recorded an impairment for a facility within the engineered building systems segment in the amount of $1.0 million related to a facility classified as held for sale as a result of deteriorating market conditions. During fiscal 2010, we recorded impairments for facilities within the engineered metal buildings and metal components segments in the amount of $1.0 million and $0.2 million, respectively, related to facilities classified as held for sale as a result of deteriorating market conditions. In determining the impairments, the fair value of assets were determined based on prices of similar assets in similar condition, adjusted for their remaining useful life. We plan to sell these facilities within the next 12 months.

We did not incur significant costs related to our three-phase restructuring in fiscal 2011 and do not expect to incur significant similar costs resulting from this restructuring plan in the future. However, we did record a $0.6 million recovery in fiscal 2011 as a result of a legal settlement for a closed facility.

 

86


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes our restructuring plan costs and charges related to the General, Phase I, Phase II and Phase III restructuring plans during each of the fiscal years presented (in thousands):

 

     Fiscal
2010
     Fiscal
2009
     Cumulative
Costs

Incurred  (1)
 

General

        

Severance

   $ 18       $ 2,987       $ 3,092   

Other Cash Costs

     88         57         145   

Asset Impairment

     4         1,234         1,238   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total General Program

     110         4,278         4,475   

Repurposing and Phase I

        

Severance

   $ 102       $ 1,016       $ 1,224   

Asset Relocation

     —           303         303   

Other Cash Costs

     285         199         484   

Asset Impairment

     971         1,634         2,762   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Plant Closing Phase I

     1,358         3,152         4,773   

Plant Closing Phase II

        

Severance

   $ —         $ 399       $ 399   

Asset Relocation

     —           22         22   

Other Cash Costs

     —           442         442   

Asset Impairment

     —           30         30   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Plant Closing Phase II

     —           893         893   

Plant Closing Phase III

        

Severance

   $ 10       $ 2,349       $ 2,359   

Asset Relocation

     26         219         245   

Other Cash Costs

     3,002         1,060         4,062   

Asset Impairment

     96         3,393         3,489   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Plant Closing Phase III

     3,134         7,021         10,155   

Total All Programs

   $ 4,602       $ 15,344       $ 20,296   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restructuring by Segment

        

Buildings

     3,022         7,522         10,605   

Components

     510         1,216         1,832   

Coaters

     —           103         103   

Corporate

     —           211         238   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,532       $ 9,052       $ 12,778   

Asset Impairments by Segment

        

Buildings

     923         4,316         5,396   

Components

     147         766         913   

Corporate

     —           1,209         1,209   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,070       $ 6,291       $ 7,518   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes costs incurred in fiscal 2008.

 

87


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes our restructuring liability related to the Phase I, Phase II and Phase III restructuring plans (in thousands):

 

     Employee  or
Severance
Costs
    Other
Costs
    Total  

Balance at November 1, 2009

   $ 1,387      $ —        $ 1,387   

Costs incurred

     130        3,402        3,532   

Cash payments

     (1,533     (3,402     (4,935

Other adjustments(1)

     16        —          16   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at October 31, 2010

   $ —        $ —        $ —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Relates to the foreign currency translation.

Fiscal 2011 Plan

In fiscal 2011, we implemented a restructuring plan (the “2011 Plan”) to close one of our sales offices in our engineered building system segments. As a result of the 2011 Plan, we recorded a $0.3 million restructuring charge in fiscal 2011 primarily related to lease termination costs.

5. RESTRICTED CASH

On May 21, 2009, we entered into a cash collateral agreement with our agent bank to obtain letters of credit secured by cash collateral. The restricted cash is invested in a cash bank account securing our agent bank. As of both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had restricted cash in the amount of $2.8 million as collateral related to our $2.7 million of letters of credit, exclusive of letters of credit under our ABL Facility. Restricted cash as of both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010 is classified as current as the underlying letters of credit expire within one year of the respective balance sheet date. The letters of credit have either automatically renewed or will be renewed upon expiration.

6. GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS

As of each of October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009, our goodwill balance was $5.2 million and was related to our engineering building systems segment. In accordance with ASC Topic 350, Intangibles — Goodwill and Other, goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually at the reporting unit level, which is defined as an operating segment or a component of an operating segment that constitutes a business for which financial information is available and is regularly reviewed by management. Prior to the impairments discussed below, management determined that we had six reporting units for the purpose of allocating goodwill and the subsequent testing of goodwill for impairment. Our metal components and engineered building systems segments were each split into two reporting units and the metal coil coating segment was its own reporting unit for goodwill impairment testing purposes.

Based on lower than projected sales volumes in our first quarter of fiscal 2009 and based on a revised lower outlook for nonresidential construction activity in 2009, management reduced the Company’s cash flow projections for fiscal 2009. We concluded that this reduction was an impairment indicator requiring us to perform an interim goodwill impairment test for each of our six reporting units as of February 1, 2009. As a result of this impairment indicator, we updated the first step of our goodwill impairment test in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. The first step of our goodwill impairment test determines fair value of the reporting unit based on a blend of estimated discounted cash flows, publicly traded company multiples and acquisition multiples reconciled to our recent publicly traded stock price, including a reasonable control premium. The result from this model was then weighted and combined into a single estimate of fair value. We determined that our carrying value exceeded our

 

88


Table of Contents

fair value at most of our reporting units in each of our operating segments, indicating that goodwill was potentially impaired. As a result, we initiated the second step of the goodwill impairment test which involved calculating the implied fair value of our goodwill by allocating the fair value of the reporting unit to all assets and liabilities other than goodwill and comparing it to the carrying amount of goodwill. The fair value of each of the reporting unit’s assets and liabilities were determined based on a combination of prices of comparable businesses and present value techniques.

As of February 1, 2009, we estimated the market implied fair value of our goodwill was less than its carrying value by approximately $508.9 million, which was recorded as a goodwill impairment charge in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. This charge was an estimate based on the result of the preliminary allocation of fair value in the second step of the goodwill impairment test. However, due to the timing and complexity of the valuation calculations required under the second step of the test, we were not able to finalize our allocation of the fair value until the second quarter of fiscal 2009 with regard to property, plant and equipment and intangible assets in which their respective values were dependent on property, plant and equipment. The finalization was included in our goodwill impairment charge of $102.5 million that was recorded in the second quarter of fiscal 2009 as discussed further below.

Further declines in cash flow projections and the corresponding implementation of the Phase III restructuring plan caused management to determine that there was an impairment indicator requiring us to perform another interim goodwill impairment test for each of our reporting units with goodwill remaining as of May 3, 2009. As a result of this impairment indicator, we again performed the first step of our goodwill impairment test in the second quarter of fiscal 2009. The results showed that our carrying value exceeded our fair value at most of our reporting units with goodwill remaining, indicating that goodwill was potentially impaired. We therefore initiated the second step of the goodwill impairment test. As of May 3, 2009, we determined the market implied fair value of our goodwill was less than the carrying value for certain reporting units by approximately $102.5 million, which was recorded as a goodwill impairment charge in the second quarter of fiscal 2009. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the remaining goodwill was $5.2 million.

At the beginning of the fourth quarter of each fiscal year, we perform an annual assessment of the recoverability of goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles. Additionally, we assess goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that such carrying values may not be recoverable. We completed our annual assessment of the recoverability of goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 and determined that no further impairments of our goodwill or long-lived intangibles were required.

 

89


Table of Contents

The following table represents all our intangible assets activity for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010 (in thousands):

 

     Range of
Life  (Years)
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Amortized intangible assets:

       

Cost:

       

Trade names

     15       $ 5,588      $ 5,588   

Customer lists and relationships

     15         8,710        8,710   

Non-competition agreements

     5-10         8,132        8,132   

Property rights

     7         990        990   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 23,420      $ 23,420   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated Amortization:

       

Trade names

      $ (2,463   $ (2,090

Customer lists and relationships

        (3,098     (2,518

Non-competition agreements

        (6,164     (5,201

Property rights

        (896     (754
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ (12,621   $ (10,563
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net book value

      $ 10,799      $ 12,857   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Indefinite-lived intangible assets:

       

Trade names, beginning of year

      $ 13,455      $ 13,455   

Impairments

        —          —     
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trade names, end of year

        13,455        13,455   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total intangible assets at net book value

      $ 24,254      $ 26,312   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

RCC’s Star and Ceco trade name assets have an indefinite life and are not amortized, but are reviewed annually and tested for impairment. The RCC trade names were determined to have indefinite lives due to the length of time the trade names have been in place, with some having been in place for decades. Our past practice with other significant acquisitions and current intentions are to maintain the trade names indefinitely.

As a result of the aforementioned goodwill impairment indicators and in accordance with ASC Subtopic 350-20, we performed an impairment analysis on our indefinite lived intangible asset related to trade names of our subsidiary, RCC in our engineered building systems segment, to determine the fair value in the first and second quarters of fiscal 2009. Based on changes to our projected cash flows in the first quarter of fiscal 2009 and based on the lower projected cash flows and related Phase III restructuring plan in the second quarter of fiscal 2009, we determined the carrying value exceeded the future fair value attributable to the indefinite-lived intangible asset, and therefore we recorded impairment charges of $8.7 million in the first quarter of fiscal 2009 and $2.4 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2009 related to the indefinite-lived intangible asset.

All other intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their expected useful lives. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the weighted average amortization period for all our intangible assets was 14.1 years and 13.6 years, respectively.

Amortization expense of intangibles was $2.1 million for each of fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009. We expect to recognize amortization expense over the next five fiscal years as follows (in thousands):

 

2012

   $ 1,746   

2013

     1,563   

2014

     1,563   

2015

     1,004   

2016

     953   

 

90


Table of Contents

In accordance with ASC Topic 350, Intangibles — Goodwill and Other, we evaluate the remaining useful life of these intangible assets on an annual basis. We also review for recoverability when events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying values may not be recoverable in accordance with ASC Topic 360, Property, Plant and Equipment.

7. SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION

During the first quarter of fiscal 2010, our board of directors unanimously adopted a resolution to submit to a vote of our stockholders a proposal to approve an amendment and restatement of our Incentive Plan to increase the number of shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under the Incentive Plan by 5.7 million shares of Common Stock (after giving effect to the Reverse Stock Split). On February 19, 2010, the stockholders approved the amendment and restatement of the Company’s Incentive Plan. The amendment and restatement of the Incentive Plan increased the number of Common Shares reserved for issuance under the Incentive Plan by 5.7 million to a total of 6.4 million Common Shares (in each case, after giving effect to the Reverse Stock Split), increased the maximum number of shares that may be granted to an individual in any fiscal year to 0.9 million and extended the effective date of the Incentive Plan to 10 years after the date the Compensation Committee of the Company’s board of directors approved the amendments.

Our 2003 Long-Term Stock Incentive Plan (“Incentive Plan”) is an equity-based compensation plan that allows us to grant a variety of types of awards, including stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, stock appreciation rights, performance share awards, phantom stock awards and cash awards. On December 11, 2009, our board of directors approved the right of employees and officers to receive grants of 1.5 million shares of restricted stock and the right of officers to receive grants of 1.8 million stock options, both of which were conditioned upon shareholder approval. Our majority stockholder, had informed the Company in writing of its intention to vote in favor of the amendment and restatement of the Incentive Plan. Based on the approval of our board of directors and our majority stockholder, we determined that the finalization of stockholder vote to approve the amendment and restatement of the Incentive Plan was perfunctory and we established a grant date of December 11, 2009 for the restricted stock and stock option awards. As discussed in Note 12 — Series B Cumulative Convertible Participating Preferred Stock, at January 31, 2010, the Company did not have sufficient common shares available to settle the restricted stock and stock option awards, and thus, we classified a portion of the awards as liability awards in accordance with ASC Subtopic 718-10, Compensation-Stock Compensation (“ASC 718-10”). ASC 718-10 requires that liability awards be remeasured at fair value at each reporting date with changes in fair value recognized in earnings. During fiscal 2010, the changes in fair value were immaterial. On March 5, 2010, the Company effected a Reverse Stock Split at an exchange ratio of 1-for-5 which caused the shares to become available and resulted in all restricted stock and stock option awards being classified as equity awards. As such, on March 5, 2010, all liability awards were reclassified to equity awards and remeasured using a valuation date of March 5, 2010. The total unrecognized compensation cost related to the share-based compensation arrangements reclassified from liability awards to equity awards was $9.9 million.

As a general rule, awards terminate on the earlier of (i) 10 years from the date of grant, (ii) 30 days after termination of employment or service for a reason other than death, disability or retirement, (iii) one year after death or (iv) one year for incentive stock options or five years for other awards after disability or retirement. Awards are non-transferable except by disposition on death or to certain family members, trusts and other family entities as the Compensation Committee of our Board of Directors (the “Committee”) may approve. Awards may be paid in cash, shares of our common stock or a combination, in lump sum or installments and currently or by deferred payment, all as determined by the Committee. As of October 30, 2011, and for all periods presented, our share-based awards under this plan have consisted of restricted stock grants and stock option grants, none of which can be settled through cash payments. Both our stock options and restricted stock awards are subject only to vesting requirements based on continued employment at the end of a specified time period and typically vest over four years or earlier upon death, disability or a change in control. However, our annual restricted stock awards also vest upon retirement and, only in the case of certain special one-time restricted stock awards, a portion vest on termination without cause or for good reason, as defined by the agreements governing such

 

91


Table of Contents

awards. In addition, our December 11, 2009 stock option grants contain restrictions on the employees’ ability to exercise and sell the options prior to January 1, 2013, or if earlier, the employees’ death, disability, or qualifying termination (as defined in the Incentive Plan), or upon a change in control of the Company. A total of approximately 1,930,000 and 2,500,000 shares were available at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, respectively, under the Incentive Plan for the further grants of awards.

Since December 2006, the Committee’s policy has been to provide for grants of restricted stock once per year, with the size of the awards based on a dollar amount set by the Committee. For executive officers and designated members of senior management, a portion of the award may be fixed and a portion may be subject to adjustment, up or down, depending on the average rate of growth in NCI’s earnings per share over the three fiscal years ended prior to the award date. The number of shares awarded on the grant date equals the dollar value specified by the Committee (after adjustment with regard to the variable portion) divided by the closing price of the stock on the grant date, or if the grant date is not a trading day, the trading day prior to the grant date. All restricted stock awards to all award recipients, including executive officers, are subject to a cap in value set by the Committee.

Our option awards and restricted stock awards are typically subject to graded vesting over a service period, which is typically four years. We recognize compensation cost for these awards on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for the entire award. In addition, certain of our awards provide for accelerated vesting upon qualified retirement, after a change of control or upon termination without cause or for good reason. We recognize compensation cost for such awards over the period from grant date to the date the employee first becomes eligible for retirement. On October 20, 2009, we completed a financial restructuring that resulted in a change of control of the Company. With the exception of certain executive officers who received 2004 Long-Term Restricted Stock Awards that vest in full only on retirement, the vesting of all unvested restricted stock and stock options within our Incentive Plan accelerated upon the change of control. As a result, we recorded $9.1 million in share-based compensation expense upon the accelerated vesting under our Incentive Plan. None of the fiscal 2010 option grants vested during fiscal 2010.

The fair value of each option award is estimated as of the date of grant using a Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing formula. Expected volatility is based on normalized historical volatility of our stock over a preceding period commensurate with the expected term of the option and adjusted to exclude the increased volatility associated with the refinancing the Company experienced in fiscal 2009 because this volatility is not relevant to the expected future volatility of the stock. The risk-free rate for the expected term of the option is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant. Expected dividend yield was not considered in the option pricing formula since we do not currently pay dividends on our Common Stock and have no current plans to do so in the future. There were no options granted during the fiscal year ended November 1, 2009. We have estimated a forfeiture rate of 10% for our non-officers and 0% for our officers in our calculation of share-based compensation expense for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009. These estimates are based on historical forfeiture behavior exhibited by our employees.

The weighted average assumptions for the equity awards granted on December 11, 2009 are noted in the following table:

 

Expected volatility

     46.05

Expected term (in years)

     5.75   

Risk-free interest rate

     2.44

 

92


Table of Contents

The weighted average assumptions for the liability awards at the December 11, 2009 grant date and the subsequent reclassification to equity awards remeasured on March 5, 2010 are noted in the following table:

 

     December 11,
2009
    March 5,
2010
 

Expected volatility

     46.05     47.01

Expected term (in years)

     5.75        5.52   

Risk-free interest rate

     2.44     2.49

During fiscal 2011 and 2010, we granted 121,669 and 1,781,729 stock options, respectively, and the weighted average grant-date fair value of options granted during fiscal 2011 and 2010 was $5.78 and $4.29, respectively. There were no options granted during the fiscal year ended November 1, 2009.

The following is a summary of stock option transactions during fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 (in thousands, except weighted average exercise prices and weighted average remaining life):

 

     Number of
Shares
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Life
     Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
 

Balance November 2, 2008

     139      $ 140.45        

Cancelled

     (8     (138.91     

Exercised

     (1     (75.75     
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

Balance November 1, 2009

     130      $ 140.63        

Granted

     1,782        8.85        

Cancelled

     (10     (113.26     
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

Balance October 31, 2010

     1,902      $ 17.33        

Granted

     122        12.00        

Cancelled

     (5     (92.80     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance October 30, 2011

     2,019      $ 16.85        7.9 years       $ 1,105   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exercisable at October 30, 2011

     561      $ 36.93        7.0 years       $ 276   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

There were no options exercised during fiscal 2011 or 2010. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during 2009 was insignificant. The following summarizes additional information concerning outstanding options at October 30, 2011 (in thousands, except weighted average remaining life and weighted average exercise prices):

 

Options Outstanding  

Number of Options

     Weighted Average
Remaining Life
     Weighted Average
Exercise Price
 
  1,921         8.1 years       $ 9.76   
  42         2.3 years         136.30   
  48         2.8 years         161.62   
  8         4.2 years         225.28   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
  2,019         7.9 years       $ 16.85   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

93


Table of Contents

The following summarizes additional information concerning options exercisable at October 30, 2011 (in thousands, except weighted average exercise prices):

 

Options Exercisable

Number of Options

     Weighted Average
Exercise Price
  463       $11.78
  43       136.30
  48       161.62
  7       225.28

 

 

    

 

  561       $36.93

 

 

    

 

The fair value of restricted stock awards classified as equity awards is based on the Company’s stock price as of the date of grant. During fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009, we granted restricted stock awards with a fair value of $6.2 million or 515,053 shares, $13.7 million or 1,498,718 shares and $6.1 million or 141,900 shares, respectively. The fair value of restricted stock awards previously classified as liability awards on March 5, 2010 is based on the Company’s stock price as of March 5, 2010, the date the contingency was resolved. Restricted stock transactions during fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 were as follows (in thousands, except weighted average grant prices):

 

     Number of
Shares
    Weighted Average
Grant Price
 

Balance November 2, 2008

     96      $ 167.97   

Granted

     142        43.27   

Distributed

     (27     180.38   

Forfeited

     (7     142.43   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance November 1, 2009

     204      $ 80.57   

Granted

     1,499        9.10   

Forfeited

     (6     9.10   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance October 31, 2010

     1,697      $ 17.70   

Granted

     515        12.00   

Distributed

     (375     9.11   

Forfeited

     (61     10.35   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance October 30, 2011

     1,776      $ 18.11   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The total recurring pre-tax share-based compensation cost that has been recognized in results of operations was $6.9 million, $5.0 million and $4.8 million for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009, respectively. Of these amounts, $6.6 million, $4.8 million and $4.3 million were included in engineering, selling, general and administrative expense for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009, respectively, with the remaining costs in each period in cost of goods sold. On October 20, 2009, upon the change of control, we recorded $9.1 million of accelerated unamortized compensation expense which was included in the change of control charges on the Consolidated Statement of Operations. As of October 30, 2011, we do not have any amounts capitalized for share-based compensation cost in inventory or similar assets. The total income tax benefit recognized in results of operations for share-based compensation arrangements was $2.7 million, $1.9 million and $5.3 million for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009, respectively. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, there was approximately $18.1 million and $18.2 million, respectively, of total unrecognized compensation cost related to share-based compensation arrangements and this cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average remaining period of 2.8 years and 3.7 years, respectively. As a result of the change of control in fiscal 2009, all compensation cost related to share-based compensation arrangements were recognized as of November 1, 2009.

 

94


Table of Contents

There was no cash received from option exercises during fiscal 2011 or 2010. Cash received from option exercises was insignificant during fiscal 2009.

8. LOSS PER COMMON SHARE

Basic loss per common share is computed by dividing net loss allocated to common shares by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding. Diluted loss per common share considers the dilutive effect of common stock equivalents. The reconciliation of the numerator and denominator used for the computation of basic and diluted loss per common share is as follows (in thousands, except per share data):

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 

Numerator for Basic and Diluted Loss Per Common Share

      

Net loss allocated to common shares

   $ (47,466   $ (311,227   $ (762,509

Less: net income allocated to participating securities(1)

     —          —          8,877   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss allocated to common shares

   $ (47,466   $ (311,227   $ (753,632
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Denominator for Basic and Diluted Loss Per Common Share

      

Weighted average common shares outstanding for basic and diluted loss per share

     18,369        18,229        4,403   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic and Diluted loss per common share

   $ (2.58   $ (17.07   $ (171.18
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Participating securities consist of the holders of the Convertible Preferred Stock, as defined below, and the unvested restricted Common Stock related to our Incentive Plan. Participating securities do not have a contractual obligation to share in losses; therefore, no losses were allocated in fiscal 2011 and 2010 above. These participating securities will be allocated earnings when applicable.

The indenture under which the Convertible Notes were issued contains a “net share settlement” provision as described in ASC Subtopic 260-10, Earnings Per Share — Overall (“ASC 260-10”), whereby conversions are settled for a combination of cash and shares, and shares are only issued to the extent the conversion value exceeds the principal amount. The incremental shares that we would have been required to issue had the Convertible Notes been converted at the average trading price during the period have been included in the diluted earnings (loss) per common share calculation because our average stock trading price had exceeded the $200.70 conversion threshold. However, during fiscal 2009, the Convertible Notes could only be converted by the holders if our stock price traded above the initial conversion price of our Convertible Notes (see Note 11) for at least 20 trading days in each of the 30 consecutive trading day period of the preceding calendar quarter or upon other specified events. At November 1, 2009, the Convertible Notes were not convertible and, as a result, had no impact on earnings (loss) per common share.

We adopted ASC Subtopic 260-10, ASC 260-10 on November 2, 2009. This pronouncement provides that unvested share-based payment awards that contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents are “participating securities” and, therefore, should be included in computing earnings per share using the two-class method. The calculation of earnings per share for Common Stock presented here has been reclassified to exclude the income, if any, attributable to the unvested restricted stock awards from the numerator and exclude the dilutive impact of those shares from the denominator. There was no income amount attributable to unvested restricted stock for fiscal 2011, fiscal 2010 and fiscal 2009 as the restricted stock does not share in the net losses. However, in periods of net income, a portion of this income will be allocable to the restricted stock. All prior period earnings per share data have been adjusted retrospectively to conform to the provisions of this pronouncement.

 

95


Table of Contents

The weighted average number of common shares outstanding increased by 0.5 million due to the completion of the Exchange Offer in October 2009. In connection with the exchange offer, we issued 14.0 million shares of Common Stock.

We calculate earnings per share using the “two-class” method, whereby unvested share-based payment awards that contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents are “participating securities” and, therefore, these participating securities are treated as a separate class in computing earnings per share. The calculation of earnings per share for Common Stock presented here excludes the income, if any, attributable to the unvested restricted stock awards and our Series B Cumulative Convertible Participating Preferred Stock (“Convertible Preferred Stock,” and shares thereof, “Preferred Shares”) from the numerator and excludes the dilutive impact of those shares from the denominator. There was no income amount attributable to unvested restricted stock or Preferred Shares for fiscal 2011, fiscal 2010 and fiscal 2009 as the restricted stock and Preferred Shares do not share in the net losses. However, in periods of net income, a portion of this income will be allocable to the restricted stock and Preferred Shares. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the Preferred Shares were convertible into 46.6 million and 44.3 million shares of Common Stock, respectively.

For the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, all options and unvested restricted shares were anti-dilutive and, therefore, not included in the diluted loss per common share calculation.

9. OTHER ACCRUED EXPENSES

Other accrued expenses are comprised of the following (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
     October 31,
2010
 

Customer deposits

   $ 7,634       $ 5,815   

Accrued warranty obligation and deferred warranty revenue

     17,941         16,977   

Accrued workers compensation and general liability insurance

     8,215         7,400   

Ad valorem tax payable

     4,047         3,427   

Other accrued expenses

     11,831         13,104   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other accrued expenses

   $ 49,668       $ 46,723   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

10. WARRANTY

The following table represents the rollforward of our accrued warranty obligation and deferred warranty revenue activity for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010 (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Beginning balance

   $ 16,977      $ 16,116   

Warranties sold

     2,924        2,885   

Revenue recognized

     (1,652     (1,408

Costs incurred and other

     (308     (616
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 17,941      $ 16,977   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

96


Table of Contents

11. LONG-TERM DEBT AND NOTE PAYABLE

Debt is comprised of the following (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
     October 31,
2010
 

Amended Credit Agreement (due April 2014, interest at 8.0%)

   $ 130,699       $ 136,305   

Asset-Based Lending Facility (due April 2014, interest at 4.75%)

     —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     130,699         136,305   

Current portion of long-term debt

     —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total long-term debt, less current portion

   $ 130,699       $ 136,305   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The scheduled maturity of our debt is as follows (in thousands):

 

2012

   $ —     

2013

     —     

2014

     130,699   

2015

     —     

2016 and thereafter

     —     
  

 

 

 
   $ 130,699   
  

 

 

 

Summary

We have an Amended Credit Agreement (the “Amended Credit Agreement”) which includes $150 million in term loans. The term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement will mature on April 20, 2014 and, prior to that date, will amortize in nominal quarterly installments equal to 0.25% of the principal amount of the term loan then outstanding as of the last day of each calendar quarter. However, we made a mandatory prepayment on the Amended Credit Agreement in May 2010 in connection with our tax refund received resulting from the carry back of the 2009 net operating loss. As a result, we are not required to make the quarterly principal payments for the remainder of the term loan, except as required by the mandatory prepayment provisions. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, amounts outstanding under our Amended Credit Agreement were $130.7 million and $136.3 million, respectively.

In addition to our Amended Credit Agreement, we have an ABL Facility which allows aggregate maximum borrowings by NCI Group, Inc. and Robertson-Ceco II Corporation of up to $125.0 million; however, the aggregate maximum borrowings are limited to $100.0 million under our Amended Credit Agreement. Borrowing availability on the ABL Facility is determined by a monthly borrowing base collateral calculation that is based on specified percentages of the value of qualified cash, eligible inventory and eligible accounts receivable, less certain reserves and subject to certain other adjustments. The ABL Facility has a maturity of April 20, 2014 and includes borrowing capacity of up to $25 million for letters of credit and up to $10 million for swingline borrowings. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, our excess availability under the ABL Facility was $87.8 million and $73.8 million, respectively. There were no amounts outstanding under the ABL Facility at both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010. In addition, at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, letters of credit totaling approximately $6.4 million and $8.1 million, respectively, were outstanding under the ABL Facility.

Amended Credit Agreement

On October 29, 2009, we entered into the Amended Credit Agreement, pursuant to which we repaid $143.3 million of the $293.3 million in principal amount of term loans outstanding under such credit agreement and modified the terms and maturity of the remaining $150.0 million balance. The terms of the term loan require quarterly principal payments in an amount equal to 0.25% of the principal amount of the term loan then

 

97


Table of Contents

outstanding as of the last day of each calendar quarter and a final payment of approximately $136.3 million at maturity on April 20, 2014. In fiscal 2011, we made optional prepayments in the amount of $5.6 million. These prepayments are allowed to be applied against the remaining required quarterly principal payments, and as a result, we are not required to make any additional quarterly principal payments for the remaining term of the term loan, although we intend to continue to make voluntary prepayments. In May 2010, we made a mandatory prepayment on the Amended Credit Agreement in the amount of $13.3 million in connection with our tax refund received resulting from the carry back of the 2009 net operating loss.

The Company’s obligations under the Amended Credit Agreement and any interest rate protection agreements or other permitted hedging agreement entered into with any lender under the Amended Credit Agreement are irrevocably and unconditionally guaranteed on a joint and several basis by each direct and indirect domestic subsidiary of the Company (other than any domestic subsidiary that is a foreign subsidiary holding company or a subsidiary of a foreign subsidiary).

The obligations under the Amended Credit Agreement and under any permitted hedging agreement and the guarantees thereof are secured by (i) all of the capital stock and other equity interests of all direct domestic subsidiaries owned by the Company and the guarantors, (ii) up to 65% of the capital stock of certain direct foreign subsidiaries of the Company or any guarantor (it being understood that a foreign subsidiary holding company or a domestic subsidiary of a foreign subsidiary will be deemed a foreign subsidiary) and (iii) substantially all other tangible and intangible assets owned by the Company and each guarantor, including liens on material real property, in each case to the extent permitted by applicable law. The liens securing the obligations under the Amended Credit Agreement, the permitted hedging agreements and the guarantees thereof are first in priority (as between the Amended Credit Agreement and the ABL Facility) with respect to stock, material real property and assets other than accounts receivable, inventory, certain deposit accounts, associated intangibles and certain other specified assets of the Company and the guarantors. Such liens are second in priority (as between the Amended Credit Agreement and the ABL Facility) with respect to accounts receivable, inventory, associated intangibles and certain other specified assets of the Company and the guarantors.

The Amended Credit Agreement contains a number of covenants that, among other things, limit or restrict our ability to dispose of assets, incur additional indebtedness, incur guarantee obligations, prepay other indebtedness, make dividends and other cash restricted payments, create liens, make investments, make acquisitions, engage in mergers, change the nature of their business and engage in certain transactions with affiliates.

The Amended Credit Agreement had no financial covenant test until October 30, 2011 (subject to prepayment deferrals as noted below), at which time our consolidated leverage ratio of net indebtedness to EBITDA must be no more than 5 to 1. Net indebtedness is defined as consolidated debt less the lesser of unrestricted cash or $50 million. This ratio steps down by 0.25 each quarter until October 28, 2012 at which time the maximum ratio is 4 to 1. The ratio continues to step down by 0.125 each quarter until November 3, 2013 to a ratio of 3.5 to 1, which remains the maximum ratio for each fiscal quarter thereafter. We will, however, not be subject to this financial covenant with respect to a specified period if certain prepayments or repurchases of the term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement are made in the specified period. Based on our prepayments made through October 30, 2011, including the mandatory prepayment in connection with our tax refund, the leverage ratio covenant has been deferred until the first quarter of fiscal 2013. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, our Amended Credit Agreement did not require any financial covenant compliance.

Term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement may be repaid at any time, without premium or penalty but subject to customary LIBOR breakage costs. We also have the ability to repurchase a portion of the term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement, subject to certain terms and conditions set forth in the Amended Credit Agreement. In addition, the Amended Credit Agreement requires mandatory prepayment and reduction in an amount equal to:

 

   

the net cash proceeds of (1) certain asset sales, (2) certain debt offerings and (3) certain insurance recovery and condemnation events; and

 

98


Table of Contents
   

50% of annual excess cash flow (as defined in the Amended Credit Agreement) for any fiscal year ending on or after October 31, 2010, unless a specified leverage ratio target of 4 to 1 is met.

The Amended Credit Agreement limited our ability to pay cash dividends on or prior to October 31, 2010 after which time we were permitted to pay dividends in an amount not to exceed the available amount (as defined in the Amended Credit Agreement). The available amount is defined as the sum of 50% of the cumulative consolidated net income from August 2, 2009 to the end of the most recent fiscal quarter, plus net proceeds of property or assets received as capital contributions, less the sum of all dividends, payments or other distributions of such available amounts, in each case subject to certain adjustments and exceptions as specified in the Amended Credit Agreement. In the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan of which we used $11.0 million as of October 30, 2011. Each quarterly dividend payment cannot be split between cash and payment-in-kind.

The term loan under the Amended Credit Agreement bears interest, at our option, at either LIBOR or Base Rate plus an applicable margin. To date, we have selected LIBOR interest rates. Overdue amounts will bear interest at a rate that is 2% higher than the rate otherwise applicable. “Base Rate” is defined as the highest of (i) the Wachovia Bank, National Association prime rate, (ii) the overnight Federal Funds rate plus 0.5%, and (iii) 3%. “LIBOR” is defined as the applicable London interbank offered rate (not to be less than 2%) adjusted for reserves. The applicable margin until October 30, 2011 will be 5.00% on Base Rate loans and 6.00% on LIBOR loans under the Amended Credit Agreement. After October 30, 2011, the LIBOR-linked margin fluctuates based on our leverage ratio and shall be either 6% or 4.5%. Based on our leverage ratio at October 30, 2011, the applicable margin in the first quarter of fiscal 2012 will be 4.5%.

In accordance with ASC Subtopic 470-50, Debt — Modifications and Extinguishments, we accounted for the amendment to our Amended Credit Agreement as a modification, and we have expensed $6.4 million of legal and other professional fees paid to third-parties in connection with amending the facility in fiscal 2009.

During June 2006, we entered into an interest rate swap agreement relating to $160 million of the term credit agreement then in effect, prior to its amendment and restatement as the Amended Credit Agreement due June 2010. The interest rate swap agreement expired in June 2010. At November 1, 2009, the notional amount of the interest rate swap agreement was $65 million. See Note 15 for further information.

ABL Facility

On October 20, 2009, the subsidiaries of the Company, NCI Group, Inc. and RCC and the Company entered into the ABL Facility pursuant to a loan and security agreement that provided for a $125.0 million asset-based loan facility. The ABL Facility allows us an aggregate maximum borrowing of up to $125.0 million; however, the aggregate maximum borrowings are limited to $100.0 million under our Amended Credit Agreement. Borrowing availability under the ABL Facility is determined by a monthly borrowing base collateral calculation that is based on specified percentages of the value of qualified cash, eligible inventory and eligible accounts receivable, less certain reserves and subject to certain other adjustments. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, our excess availability under the ABL Facility was $87.8 million and $73.8 million, respectively. The ABL Facility has a maturity of April 20, 2014 and includes borrowing capacity of up to $25 million for letters of credit and up to $10 million for swingline borrowings. Under the ABL Facility, there were no amounts of borrowings outstanding at both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010. In addition, at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, standby letters of credit totaling approximately $6.4 million and $8.1 million, respectively, were issued under the ABL Facility.

On December 3, 2010, we finalized an amendment of our ABL Facility that reduces the unused commitment fee from 1% or 0.75% based on the average daily balance of loans and letters of credit obligations outstanding to

 

99


Table of Contents

an annual rate of 0.5%. The calculation is determined on the amount by which the maximum credit exceeds the average daily principal balance of outstanding loans and letter of credit obligations. Additional customary fees in connection with the ABL Facility also apply. In addition, the amendment reduces the effective interest rate on borrowings, if any, by nearly 40% or 175 basis points. It also relaxes the prohibitions against making restricted payments or paying cash dividends, including on the Convertible Preferred Stock, to allow, in the aggregate, up to $6.5 million of restricted payments or cash dividends each calendar quarter, provided (i) certain excess availability conditions or (ii) certain other excess availability conditions and a fixed charge coverage ratio under the ABL Facility are satisfied.

The obligations of the borrowers under the ABL Facility are guaranteed by us and each direct and indirect domestic subsidiary of the Company (other than any domestic subsidiary that is a foreign subsidiary holding company or a subsidiary of a foreign subsidiary) that is not a borrower under the ABL Facility. Our obligations under certain specified bank products agreements are guaranteed by each borrower and each other direct and indirect domestic subsidiary of the Company and the other guarantors. These guarantees are made pursuant to a guarantee agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, entered into by the Company and each other guarantor with Wells Fargo Foothill, LLC, as administrative agent.

The obligations under the ABL Facility and the guarantees thereof are secured by a first priority lien on our accounts receivable, inventory, certain deposit accounts, associated intangibles and certain other specified assets of the Company and a second priority lien on the assets securing the term loans under the Amended Credit Agreement on a first-lien basis.

The ABL Facility contains a number of covenants that, among other things, limit or restrict our ability to dispose of assets, incur additional indebtedness, incur guarantee obligations, engage in sale and leaseback transactions, prepay other indebtedness, modify organizational documents and certain other agreements, create restrictions affecting subsidiaries, make dividends and other restricted payments, create liens, make investments, make acquisitions, engage in mergers, change the nature of their business and engage in certain transactions with affiliates.

Under the ABL Facility, a “Dominion Event” occurs if either an event of default is continuing or excess availability falls below certain levels, during which period, and for certain periods thereafter, the administrative agent may apply all amounts in the Company’s, the borrowers’ and other guarantors’ concentration accounts to the repayment of the loans outstanding under the ABL Facility, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement. In addition, during such Dominion Event, we are required to make mandatory payments on our ABL Facility upon the occurrence of certain events, including the sale of assets and the issuance of debt, in each case subject to certain limitations and conditions set forth in the ABL Facility.

The ABL Facility includes a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of one to one, which will apply if we fail to maintain at least $15 million of minimum borrowing capacity. The minimum level of borrowing capacity as of both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010 was $15.0 million.

Loans under the ABL Facility bear interest, at our option, as follows:

(1) Base Rate loans at the Base Rate plus a margin. The margin ranges from 1.50% to 2.00% depending on the quarterly average excess availability under such facility, and

(2) LIBOR loans at LIBOR plus a margin. The margin ranges from 2.50% to 3.00% depending on the quarterly average excess availability under such facility.

During an event of default, loans under the ABL Facility will bear interest at a rate that is 2% higher than the rate otherwise applicable. “Base rate” is defined as the higher of the Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. prime rate or the overnight Federal Funds rate plus 0.5% and “LIBOR” is defined as the applicable London interbank offered rate adjusted for reserves.

 

100


Table of Contents

Insurance Note Payable

The note payable is related to financed insurance premiums. As of both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had outstanding a note payable in the amount of $0.3 million. Insurance premium financings are generally secured by the unearned premiums under such policies.

Convertible Notes

On November 2, 2009, we adopted ASC 470-20 which clarifies the accounting for convertible debt instruments that may be settled entirely or partially in cash upon conversion. ASC 470-20 has been applied retrospectively to fiscal years 2005 through 2009 as it relates to our Convertible Notes. As a result, we recorded a cumulative effect of the change to retained earnings in the amount of $9.5 million. At both October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had $24.5 million in additional paid in capital related to the Convertible Notes.

In October 2009, we consummated the Exchange Offer to acquire $180 million aggregate principal amount of the Convertible Notes, which resulted in the tender offer of $179.9 million in principal amount of the Convertible Notes in exchange for 14.0 million shares of our Common Stock and $90 million in cash. On December 29, 2009, we redeemed the $58,750 principal amount of the Convertible Notes that remained outstanding after the closing of the Exchange Offer. The remaining unamortized discount was reversed upon the consummation of the Exchange Offer. The amount of contractual coupon interest and amortization of the discount was $3.8 million and $8.4 million, respectively, during fiscal 2009. The effective interest rate was 7.5% during fiscal 2009.

During fiscal 2009, in accordance with ASC Subtopic 470-50, Debt — Modifications and Extinguishments, we recorded $85.3 million of debt extinguishment costs and $5.7 million of capitalized equity raising costs.

The debt extinguishment costs were determined based on the net of the inducement loss and the settlement gain. As the Convertible Notes were “Instrument C” as defined in ASC Subtopic 815-15, Embedded Derivatives, we applied the guidance in ASC Subtopic 470-20, Debt with Conversion and Other Options (“ASC 470-20”), for any inducement to convert, and then applied the guidance in ASC 470-20 on the conversion of an instrument that would normally settle the conversion spread in shares and the face amount in cash. As a result, we recorded a loss of $85.3 million, which was the net impact of the loss incurred through the induced conversion offset by the gain recorded for the extinguishment of the recognized liability under conversion accounting. In accordance with the original conversion terms of the Convertible Notes, the expected fair value of Common Stock issuable upon conversion is approximately $11.3 million (based on a $12.55 closing stock price for Common Stock as of October 19, 2009) as compared to the expected fair value of Common Stock issuable pursuant to the Exchange Offer of approximately $266.1 million ($176.1 million in Common Stock plus $90 million in cash paid). This resulted in an induced conversion charge of $254.9 million. Additionally, we also had to consider the original terms of the Convertible Notes, which required us to satisfy the accreted value of the obligation in cash and allowed us to satisfy the excess conversion value over the accreted value in either cash or shares. However, as of the date the Convertible Notes were converted, the stated conversion price of the Convertible Notes was less than the stock price. Based upon the stated conversion terms of the Convertible Notes and the stock price on the date the Convertible Notes were converted, the value of the Company’s cash settlement to the holders of the Convertible Notes would have been approximately $11.3 million. Upon settlement of a security with the characteristics of “Instrument C”, ASC 470-20-40-12 requires only the cash payment be considered in the computation of the gain or loss on the extinguishment of the recognized liability. As of the close of the market on October 19, 2009, each conversion feature was worth a value of approximately $62.53 ($12.55 closing stock price x conversion rate of 4.9824 shares per $1,000 of principal). Accordingly, the Company recognized a gain of $169.6 million which included $0.8 million of unamortized debt discount and a gain of $937.47 for each note. The change in conversion rate based on a $12.55 closing stock price for Common Stock as of October 19, 2009 resulted in a gain on extinguishment of the recognized liability of $169.6 million.

 

101


Table of Contents

12. SERIES B CUMULATIVE CONVERTIBLE PARTICIPATING PREFERRED STOCK

The CD&R Equity Investment

On August 14, 2009, the Company entered into an Investment Agreement (as amended, the “Investment Agreement”), by and between the Company and Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. (“CD&R Fund VIII”), pursuant to which the Company agreed to issue and sell to CD&R Fund VIII, and CD&R Fund VIII agreed to purchase from the Company, for an aggregate purchase price of $250 million (less reimbursement to CD&R Fund VIII or direct payment to its service providers of up to $14.5 million in the aggregate of transaction expenses and a deal fee, paid to Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, Inc., the manager of CD&R Fund VIII, of $8.25 million), 250,000 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock. Pursuant to the Investment Agreement, on October 20, 2009 (the “Closing Date”), the Company issued and sold to the CD&R Fund VIII and CD&R Friends & Family Fund VIII, L.P. (the “CD&R Funds”), and the CD&R Funds purchased from the Company, an aggregate of 250,000 Preferred Shares, representing approximately 39.2 million shares of Common Stock (after giving effect to the Reverse Stock Split) or 68.4% of the voting power and Common Stock of the Company on an as-converted basis as of the Closing Date (such purchase and sale, the “CD&R Equity Investment”). At October 30, 2011, the CD&R Funds own 70.1% of the voting power and Common Stock of the Company on an as-converted basis.

Certain Terms of the Convertible Preferred Stock

In connection with the consummation of the Equity Investment, on October 19, 2009, the Company filed the Certificate of Designations of the Convertible Preferred Stock (the “Certificate of Designations”) setting forth the terms, rights, powers, and preferences, and the qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof, of the Convertible Preferred Stock.

Liquidation Value. Each Preferred Share has an initial liquidation preference of $1,000.

Rank. The Convertible Preferred Stock ranks senior as to dividend rights, redemption payments and rights upon liquidation to the Common Stock and each other class of series of the Company’s equity securities, whether currently issued or to be issued in the future, that by its terms ranks junior to the Convertible Preferred Stock, and junior to each class or series of equity securities of the Company, whether currently issued or issued in the future, that by its terms ranks senior to the Convertible Preferred Stock. The Company does not have any outstanding securities ranking senior to the Convertible Preferred Stock. Pursuant to the Certificate of Designations, the issuance of any senior securities of the Company requires the approval of the holders of the Convertible Preferred Stock.

Dividends. Dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock are payable, on a cumulative daily basis, as and if declared by the board of directors, at a rate per annum of 12% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus accrued and unpaid dividends thereon or at a rate per annum of 8% of the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share plus any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon if paid in cash on the dividend payment date on which such dividends would otherwise compound. If dividends are not paid on the dividend payment date, either in cash or in-kind, such dividends compound on the dividend payment date. Members of the board of directors who are not affiliated with the CD&R Funds have the right to choose whether such dividends are paid in cash or in-kind, subject to the conditions of the Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility. The Company’s Amended Credit Agreement currently restricts the payment of cash dividends to 50% of cumulative earnings beginning with the fourth quarter of 2009, and in the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan of which the Company used $11.0 million as of October 30, 2011.

Each quarterly dividend payment cannot be split between cash and payment-in-kind. The Company’s ABL Facility, among other potentially available baskets, permits the Company to pay cash dividends, including on the Convertible Preferred Stock, up to $6.5 million each calendar quarter, provided (i) certain excess availability conditions or (ii) certain other excess availability conditions and a fixed charge coverage ratio under the ABL Facility are satisfied.

 

102


Table of Contents

If, at any time after the 30-month anniversary of the Closing Date of October 20, 2009 (i.e., March 20, 2012), the trading price of the Common Stock exceeds $12.75, which is 200% of the initial conversion price of the Convertible Preferred Stock ($6.3740, as adjusted for any stock dividends, splits, combinations or similar events), for each of 20 consecutive trading days (the “Dividend Rate Reduction Event”), the dividend rate (excluding any applicable adjustments as a result of a default) will become 0.00%. However, this does not preclude the payment of default dividends after the 30-month anniversary of the Closing Date. As a result of certain restrictions on dividend payments in the Company’s Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility, the dividends for each quarter of fiscal 2010 were paid in-kind, at a pro rata rate of 12% per annum. The dividends for the December 15, 2010 and March 15, 2011 dividend payments were paid in cash and the dividends for the June 15, 2011 dividend payment was paid in-kind at a pro rata rate of 12% per annum. As a result of the Consent and Waiver Agreement (discussed below), the September 15, 2011 dividend payment was paid in-kind, at a pro rata rate of 8% per annum. See Note 11 — Long-term Debt and Note Payable for more information on the Company’s Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility.

At any time prior to the Dividend Rate Reduction Event, if dividends are not declared in cash on the applicable dividend declaration date, the rate at which such dividends are payable will be at least 12% per annum. Prior to the vote of the Dividend Payment Committee, the Company is obligated to the 12% dividend rate. Therefore, the Company accrues dividends daily based on the 12% rate and if and when the Company determines the dividends will be paid at a different rate due to either cash payment on the applicable dividend declaration date or obtaining a waiver, the Company will record a subsequent benefit of the excess 4% accrual upon the board’s declaration of such cash dividend and reverse the beneficial conversion feature charge associated with such accrual.

The dividend rate will increase by 6% per annum above the rates described in the preceding paragraph upon and during certain defaults specified in the Certificate of Designations involving the Company’s failure to have a number of authorized and unissued shares of Common Stock reserved and available sufficient for the conversion of all outstanding Preferred Shares. The Company currently has sufficient authorized, unissued and reserved shares of Common Stock.

On the Dividend Payment date, the Company has the right to choose whether dividends are paid in cash or in-kind. However, the first dividend payment which was scheduled to be paid on December 15, 2009 in the amount of $4.6 million, was required to be paid in cash by the Certificate of Designations but could not be paid in cash based on the terms of the Company’s Amended Credit Agreement and Asset-Based Lending Facility (“ABL Facility”) which restricted the Company’s ability to pay cash dividends until the first quarter of fiscal 2011 and until October 20, 2010, respectively. As a result, the dividend for the period up to the December 15, 2009 dividend declaration date compounded at a rate of 12% per annum. The Company currently cannot pay this dividend in cash because the Company’s Amended Credit Agreement currently restricts the payment of cash dividends to 50% of cumulative earnings beginning with the fourth quarter of 2009, and in the absence of accumulated earnings, cash dividends and other cash restricted payments are limited to $14.5 million in the aggregate during the term of the loan of which the Company used $11.0 million as of October 30, 2011. Each quarterly dividend payment cannot be split between cash and payment-in-kind.

In addition to any dividends declared and paid as described in the preceding paragraphs, holders of the outstanding Preferred Shares also have the right to participate equally and ratably, on an as-converted basis, with the holders of shares of Common Stock in all cash dividends and distributions paid on the Common Stock.

We paid the September 15, 2011 dividend payment on the Preferred Shares in-kind. On September 6, 2011, we entered into a Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock, agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended September 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of

 

103


Table of Contents

Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares, and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the remainder of its fiscal year ending October 30, 2011, subject to certain exceptions.

The September 6, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after September 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 30, 2011.

In view of the September 6, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent, the Dividend Payment Committee of the board of directors declared and directed the payment of the September 15, 2011 dividend on the Preferred Shares in-kind at the reduced rate of 8% per annum. As a result, a dividend of 5,781.0242 shares was paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock for the period from June 16, 2011 to September 15, 2011. As a result of accruing the dividend at the stated 12% rate, and subsequently agreeing to the lower 8% rate, the Company recorded a dividend accrual reversal of $1.4 million in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 related to dividends accrued between June 16, 2011 and July 31, 2011. Similarly, the Company recorded a beneficial conversion feature reversal of $1.1 million in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 related to beneficial conversion feature charges between June 16, 2011 and July 31, 2011.

On June 15, 2011, the Dividend Payment Committee of the board of directors declared and paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, the CD&R Funds, a dividend of 8,416.9531 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock for the period from March 16, 2011 to June 15, 2011. On March 15, 2011, the Dividend Payment Committee of the board of directors declared and paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, the CD&R Funds, a $5.5 million cash dividend at a pro rata rate of 8% per annum. As a result of paying an 8% cash dividend, the Company recorded a dividend accrual reversal of $2.7 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2011 related to dividends accrued in excess of 8% between December 16, 2010 and March 15, 2011. In addition, the Company reversed the related beneficial conversion feature previously recorded of $8.2 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2011 related to the paid-in-kind dividends accrued between December 16, 2010 and March 15, 2011.

On December 15, 2010, the Dividend Payment Committee of the board of directors declared and paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, the CD&R Funds, a $5.55 million cash dividend at a pro rata rate of 8% per annum. As a result of paying an 8% cash dividend, the Company recorded a dividend accrual reversal of $2.5 million in the first quarter of fiscal 2011 related to dividends accrued in excess of 8% between September 16, 2010 and December 15, 2010. In addition, the Company reversed the related beneficial conversion feature previously recorded of $5.1 million in the first quarter of fiscal 2011 related to the paid-in-kind dividends accrued between September 16, 2010 and December 15, 2010.

On September 15, 2010, the Dividend Payment Committee of our board of directors declared and paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, the CD&R Funds, a dividend of 8,169.8438 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock for the period from June 16, 2010 through September 15, 2010. On June 15, 2010, the Dividend Payment Committee of our board of directors declared and paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, the CD&R Funds, a dividend of 7,971.8137 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock for the period from March 16, 2010 through June 15, 2010. On March 17, 2010, the Dividend Payment Committee of our board of directors declared and paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, the CD&R Funds, a dividend of 6,361.5815 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock for the period from December 16, 2009 through March 15, 2010.

Convertibility and Antidilution Adjustments. To the extent that we have authorized but unissued shares of Common Stock, holders of Preferred Shares have the right, at any time and from time to time, at their option, to convert any or all of their Preferred Shares, in whole or in part, into fully paid and non-assessable shares of the Company’s Common Stock at the conversion price set forth in the Certificate of Designations. The number of shares of Common Stock into which a Preferred Share is convertible is determined by dividing the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share and the accrued and unpaid dividends of such share as of the time of conversion by the conversion price in effect at the time of conversion.

 

104


Table of Contents

The initial conversion price of the Convertible Preferred Stock was equal to $6.3740, as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split. The conversion price is subject to adjustment as set forth in the Certificate of Designations and is subject to customary anti-dilution adjustments, including stock dividends, splits, combinations or similar events and issuance of our Common Stock at a price below the then-current market price and, within the first three years after the Closing Date, issuances of our Common Stock below the then applicable conversion price.

Milestone Redemption Right. The Company has the right, at any time on or after the tenth anniversary of the Closing Date, to redeem in whole, but not in part, all then-issued and outstanding shares of Convertible Preferred Stock in accordance with the procedures set forth in the Certificate of Designations. Any holder of Convertible Preferred Stock has the right, at any time on or after the tenth anniversary of the Closing Date, to require that the Company redeem all, but not less than all, of its shares of Convertible Preferred Stock in accordance with the procedures set forth in the Certificate of Designations. In each case, such right (the “Milestone Redemption Right”), is exercisable at a redemption price for each Preferred Share equal to the sum of the liquidation preference of $1,000 per Preferred Share and the accrued and unpaid dividends of such share as of the time of redemption.

Change of Control Redemption Right. Upon certain change of control events specified in the Certificate of Designations, including certain business combinations involving the Company and certain changes to the beneficial ownership of the voting power of the Company, so long as the CD&R Funds do not own 45% or more of the voting power of the Company and directors designated by the CD&R Funds are not entitled to cast a majority of the total number of votes that can be cast by the Company’s board of directors or by the directors constituting the quorum approving or recommending such change of control event, holders of Preferred Shares are able to require redemption by the Company, in whole but not in part, of the Convertible Preferred Stock (1) if redeemed after the fourth anniversary of the Closing Date, at a purchase price equal to the sum of the liquidation value of such Preferred Shares and the accrued and unpaid dividends thereon as of the redemption date or (2) if redeemed prior to the fourth anniversary of the Closing Date, at a purchase price equal to the sum of (a) the liquidation value of such Preferred Shares plus the accrued and unpaid dividends thereon as of the redemption date and (b) a make-whole premium equal to the net present value of the sum of all dividends that would otherwise be payable on and after the redemption date, to and including such fourth anniversary date, assuming that such dividends are paid in cash. In addition, upon change of control events pursuant to the Amended Credit Agreement or the ABL Facility, holders of Preferred Shares are able to require redemption by the Company, in whole but not in part, of the Convertible Preferred Stock, at a purchase price equal to 101% of the sum of the liquidation value of such Preferred Shares and the accrued and unpaid dividends thereon as of the redemption date.

In the event of a merger or other business combination resulting in a change of control in which the holders of shares of our Common Stock receive cash or securities of an unaffiliated entity as consideration for such shares, if the holder of Preferred Shares does not exercise the change of control redemption right described in the paragraph above or is not entitled to the change of control redemption right in connection with such event, such holder will be entitled to receive, pursuant to such merger or business combination, the consideration such holder would have received for its Preferred Shares had it converted such shares immediately prior to the merger or business combination transaction. In the event of a merger or other business combination not resulting in a change of control in which the holders of shares of our Common Stock receive cash or securities of an unaffiliated entity as consideration for such shares, holders of Convertible Preferred Stock shall have the option to exchange their Preferred Shares for shares of the surviving entity’s capital stock having terms, preferences, rights, privileges and powers no less favorable than the terms, preferences, rights, privileges and powers under the Certificate of Designations.

Vote. Holders of Preferred Shares generally are entitled to vote with the holders of the shares of the Company’s Common Stock on all matters submitted for a vote of holders of shares of the Company’s Common Stock (voting together with the holders of shares of the Company’s Common Stock as one class) and are entitled to a number of votes equal to the number shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of such holder’s

 

105


Table of Contents

Preferred Shares (without any limitations based on our authorized but unissued shares of the Company’s Common Stock) as of the applicable record date for the determination of stockholders entitled to vote on such matters.

Certain matters require the approval of the holders of a majority of the outstanding Preferred Shares, voting as a separate class, including (1) amendments or modifications to the Company’s Certificate of Incorporation, by-laws or the Certificate of Designations, that would adversely affect the terms or the powers, preferences, rights or privileges of the Convertible Preferred Stock, (2) authorization, creation, increase in the authorized amount of, or issuance of any class or series of senior securities or any security convertible into, or exchangeable or exercisable for, shares of senior securities and (3) any increase or decrease in the authorized number of Preferred Shares or the issuance of additional Preferred Shares.

In addition, in the event that the Company fails to fulfill its obligations to redeem the Convertible Preferred Stock in accordance with the terms of the Certificate of Designations following the exercise of the Milestone Redemption Right or change of control redemption rights described above, until such failure is remedied, certain additional actions of the Company shall require the approval of the holders of a majority of the outstanding Preferred Shares, voting as a separate class, including the adoption of an annual budget, the hiring and firing, or the changing of the compensation, of executive officers and the commitment, resolution or agreement to effect any business combination.

Restriction on Dividends on Junior Securities. The Company is prohibited from (i) paying any dividend with respect to the Company’s Common Stock or other junior securities, except for ordinary cash dividends in which the Convertible Preferred Stock participates and which are declared, paid or set aside after the base dividend rate for the Convertible Preferred Stock has been reduced to 0.00% as described above and dividends payable solely in shares of our Common Stock or other junior securities, or (ii) repurchasing or redeeming any shares of our Common Stock or other junior securities, unless, in each case, we have sufficient access to lawful funds immediately following such action such that we would be legally permitted to redeem in full all Preferred Shares then outstanding.

Accounting for Convertible Preferred Stock

The following is a reconciliation of the initial proceeds to the opening balance of our Convertible Preferred Shares (in thousands):

 

     Convertible
Preferred
Stock
 

Initial proceeds

   $ 250,000   

Direct transaction costs

     (27,730

Bifurcated embedded derivative liability, net of tax

     (641
  

 

 

 

Balance at October 20, 2009

     221,629 (1) 

 

(1) The $28.4 million difference between the book value and the initial liquidation preference is accreted using the effective interest rate method from the execution of the contract to the Milestone Redemption Right date or 10 years.

 

106


Table of Contents

The Company’s Convertible Preferred Shares balance and changes in the carrying amount of the Convertible Preferred Stock are as follows (in thousands):

 

     Dividends
and
Accretion
    Convertible
Preferred
Stock
 

Balance as of October 31, 2010

     $ 256,870   

Accretion

     680     

Accrued paid-in-kind dividends(1)

     8,051     

Reversal of additional 4% accrued dividends(2)

     (2,501  
  

 

 

   

Subtotal

       6,230   

Payment of cash dividend(3)

       (5,550
    

 

 

 

Balance as of January 30, 2011

       257,550   

Accretion

     680     

Accrued paid-in-kind dividends(1)

     8,325     

Reversal of additional 4% accrued dividends(4)

     (2,745  
  

 

 

   

Subtotal

       6,260   

Payment of cash dividend(5)

       (5,489
    

 

 

 

Balance as of May 1, 2011

       258,321   

Accretion

     680     

Accrued paid-in-kind dividends(1)

     8,496     
  

 

 

   

Subtotal

       9,176   
    

 

 

 

Balance as of July 31, 2011

       267,497   

Accretion

     681     

Accrued paid-in-kind dividends(1)

     8,663     

Reversal of additional 4% accrued dividends(6)

     (2,891  
  

 

 

   

Subtotal

       6,453   
    

 

 

 

Balance as of October 30, 2011

     $ 273,950   
    

 

 

 

 

(1) Dividends are accrued at the 12% rate on a daily basis until the dividend declaration date.
(2) The reversal of the additional 4% accrued dividends relates to the period from September 16, 2010 to December 15, 2010.
(3) The payment of the December 15, 2010 cash dividend relates to the period from September 16, 2010 to December 15, 2010.
(4) The reversal of the additional 4% accrued dividends relates to the period from December 16, 2010 to March 15, 2011.
(5) The payment of the March 15, 2011 cash dividend relates to the period from December 16, 2010 to March 15, 2011.
(6) The CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock, agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares in respect of the quarterly dividend payment period ending September 15, 2011 computed at the rate of 8% per annum, rather than the 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares. The reversal of the additional 4% accrued dividends relates to the period from June 16, 2011 to September 15, 2011.

In accordance with ASC Topic 815, Derivatives and Hedging, and ASC Topic 480, Distinguishing Liabilities from Equity, the Company classified the Convertible Preferred Stock as mezzanine equity because the Convertible Preferred Stock (1) can be settled in cash or shares of our Common Stock, (2) contains change of control rights allowing for early redemption, and (3) contains Milestone Redemption Rights which allow the Convertible Preferred Stock to remain outstanding without a stated maturity date.

In addition, the Certificate of Designations, which is the underlying contract of the Convertible Preferred Stock, includes features that are required to be bifurcated and recorded at fair value. We classified the Convertible Preferred Stock as an equity host contract because of (1) the voting rights, (2) the participating

 

107


Table of Contents

dividends on Common Stock and mandatory, cumulative preferred stock dividends, and (3) the Milestone Redemption Right which allows the Convertible Preferred Stock to remain outstanding without a stated maturity date. We then determined that the conditions resulting in the application of the default dividend rate are not clearly and closely related to this equity host contract and we bifurcated and separately recorded these features at fair value (See Note 15 Derivative Instruments and Hedging Strategy).

Because the dividends accrue and accumulate on a daily basis and the amount payable upon redemption of the Convertible Preferred Stock is the liquidation preference plus accrued and unpaid dividends, accrued dividends are recorded into Convertible Preferred Stock.

In accordance with ASC Subtopic 470-20, Debt with Conversion and Other Options, the Convertible Preferred Stock contains a beneficial conversion feature because it was issued with an initial conversion price of $6.3740 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split) and the closing stock price per Common Stock just prior to the execution of the CD&R Equity Investment was $12.55 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split). The intrinsic value of the beneficial conversion feature cannot exceed the issuance proceeds of the Convertible Preferred Stock less the cash paid to the CDR Funds, and thus is $241.4 million as of October 20, 2009. At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, all of the potentially 46.6 million and 44.3 million shares of Common Stock, respectively, issuable upon conversion of the Preferred Shares, which includes paid-in-kind dividends, were authorized and unissued.

As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the Preferred Shares are convertible into 46.6 million and 44.3 million shares of Common Stock, respectively, at an initial conversion price of $6.3740 (as adjusted for the Reverse Stock Split). However, as of November 1, 2009, only approximately 1.8 million shares of Common Stock were authorized and unissued, and therefore, the CD&R Funds were not able to fully convert the Preferred Shares. To the extent the CD&R Funds opted to convert their Preferred Shares, as of November 1, 2009, their conversion right was limited to conversion of that portion of their Preferred Shares into the approximately 1.8 million shares of Common Stock that were currently authorized and unissued. Upon previous action taken by the independent, non-CD&R board members, on March 5, 2010, the Company effected the Reverse Stock Split in which every five shares of Common Stock that were issued and outstanding were automatically combined into one issued and outstanding share of Common Stock. As of that date, the Preferred Shares accrued for and held by the CD&R Funds were fully convertible into 41.0 million Common Shares. As a result of the Reverse Stock Split on March 5, 2010, we recorded a beneficial conversion feature charge in the amount of $230.9 million in the second quarter of fiscal 2010 related to the availability of shares of Common Stock into which the CD&R Funds may convert their Preferred Shares. In addition, the Company recorded an additional $19.4 million beneficial conversion feature charge in fiscal 2010 related to dividends that have accrued and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. In fiscal 2011, we recorded a net $9.4 million beneficial conversion feature charge related to dividends that have accrued and are convertible into shares of Common Stock. In addition, the Company expects to recognize additional beneficial conversion feature charges on paid-in-kind dividends to the extent that the Preferred Shares are accrued with a conversion price below the prevailing fair market value of the Company’s Common Stock. The Company’s policy is to recognize beneficial conversion feature charges on paid-in-kind dividends based on a daily dividend recognition and the daily closing stock price of the Company’s Common Stock.

The Company’s aggregate liquidation preference plus accrued dividends of the Convertible Preferred Stock for fiscal 2011 and 2010 are as follows (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
     October 31,
2010
 

Liquidation preference

   $ 286,701       $ 272,503   

Accrued cash and Preferred Stock dividends

     10,102         9,983   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 296,803       $ 282,486   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

108


Table of Contents

At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, we had Preferred Shares outstanding of 286,701 and 272,503, respectively.

13. REDEEMABLE COMMON STOCK

Under federal securities laws, shares of the Company’s Common Stock purchased on behalf of participants in our Company’s 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan (the “Plan”) are required to be registered with the SEC or sold in transactions that are exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933. On February 7, 2011, the Company discovered that it inadvertently issued more shares of the Company’s Common Stock in connection with the Plan than had been registered with the SEC. As a result, certain participants in the Plan may bring claims against the Company for rescission or damages in respect of the unregistered shares for an amount equal to the purchase price for the shares (or if the shares have been disposed of, to receive damages with respect to any loss on such disposition) plus interest, less income, from the date of purchase, although the Company believes that such claims would be time barred. Moreover, even if such claims were allowed, the Company believes that the statute of limitations applicable to any such claims would be one year under the federal securities laws, and that the statute of limitations with respect to the inadvertent issuances that occurred prior to August 1, 2010 has expired. Accordingly, at October 30, 2011, approximately 0.1 million shares ($0.8 million) of the Company’s Common Stock were classified outside stockholders’ equity as redeemable common stock because of the potential rescission rights. We have determined that the potential damage claims with respect to unregistered Company Common Stock are related to purchases made under the Plan between October 31, 2010 and February 15, 2011. The redeemable common stock will be reclassified into permanent equity upon the expiration of the potential rescission rights associated with those common shares. In addition, we may be subject to civil and other penalties by regulatory authorities as a result of the failure to register. We believe that the potential negative impact on our Consolidated Statements of Operations will not be material.

14. RELATED PARTIES

Pursuant to the Investment Agreement and a Stockholders Agreement (the “Stockholders Agreement”), dated as of the Closing Date between the Company and the CD&R Funds, the CD&R Funds have the right to designate a number of directors to our board of directors that is equivalent to the CD&R Funds’ percentage interest in the Company. Among other directors appointed by the CD&R Funds, our board of directors appointed to the board of directors James G. Berges, Nathan K. Sleeper and Jonathan L. Zrebiec. Messrs. Berges and Sleeper are partners and Mr. Zrebiec is a principal of Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, LLC, (“CD&R, LLC”), an affiliate of the CD&R Funds.

As a result of their respective positions with CD&R, LLC and its affiliates, one or more of Messrs. Berges, Sleeper and Zrebiec may be deemed to have an indirect material interest in certain agreements executed in connection with the Equity Investment. Messrs. Berges, Sleeper and Zrebiec may be deemed to have an indirect material interest in the following agreements:

• the Investment Agreement, pursuant to which the CD&R Funds acquired a 68.4% interest in the Company, CD&R Fund VIII’s transaction expenses were reimbursed and a deal fee of $8.25 million was paid to CD&R, Inc., the predecessor to the investment management business of CD&R, LLC, on the Closing Date;

• the Stockholders Agreement, which sets forth certain terms and conditions regarding the Equity Investment and the CD&R Funds’ ownership of the Preferred Shares, including certain restrictions on the transfer of the Preferred Shares and the shares of our common stock issuable upon conversion thereof and on certain actions of the CD&R Funds and their controlled affiliates with respect to the Company, and to provide for, among other things, subscription rights, corporate governance rights and consent rights as well as other obligations and rights;

• a Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date (the “Registration Rights Agreement”), between the Company and the CD&R Funds, pursuant to which the Company granted to the CD&R Funds,

 

109


Table of Contents

together with any other stockholder of the Company that may become a party to the Registration Rights Agreement in accordance with its terms, certain customary registration rights with respect to the shares of our common stock issuable upon conversion of the Preferred Shares; and

• an Indemnification Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date between the Company, NCI Group, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, Robertson-Ceco II Corporation, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, the CD&R Funds and CD&R, Inc., pursuant to which the Company, NCI Group, Inc. and Robertson-Ceco II Corporation agreed to indemnify CD&R, Inc., the CD&R Funds and their general partners, the special limited partner of CD&R Fund VIII and any other investment vehicle that is a stockholder of the Company and is managed by CD&R, Inc. or any of its affiliates, their respective affiliates and successors and assigns and the respective directors, officers, partners, members, employees, agents, representatives and controlling persons of each of them, or of their respective partners, members and controlling persons, against certain liabilities arising out of the Equity Investment and transactions in connection with the Equity Investment, including, but not limited to, the Amended Credit Agreement, the ABL Facility, the Exchange Offer, and certain other liabilities and claims.

15. DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS AND HEDGING STRATEGY

Foreign Currency Risk

We are exposed to foreign currency risk associated with fluctuations in the foreign currency exchange rates on certain purchase orders denominated in a foreign currency related to the purchase of certain equipment. During fiscal 2011, we entered into various forward contracts to pay U.S. dollars and receive Euros. All contracts have been designated as cash flow hedges. The fair value of the foreign currency contracts is $0.04 million at October 30, 2011. The foreign currency contracts take into consideration the current creditworthiness of us or the counterparty, as applicable, and are included in prepaid expense and other in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Accumulated other comprehensive income will amortize over the life of the equipment purchased.

Interest Rate Risk

We are exposed to interest rate risk associated with fluctuations in the interest rates on our variable interest rate debt. We previously managed this risk by entering into a forward interest rate swap agreement (“Swap Agreement”) hedging a portion of our then $400 million Credit Agreement. The Swap Agreement expired on June 17, 2010 and, therefore, there was no remaining notional amount outstanding on October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010. At inception, we designated the Swap Agreement as a cash flow hedge. The fair value of the Swap Agreement excluded accrued interest and took into consideration current interest rates and current creditworthiness of us or the counterparty, as applicable.

During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, in connection with our refinancing and Amended Credit Agreement, we modified the terms of our credit agreement to include a 2% LIBOR minimum market interest rate. At that time, based on the current expected LIBOR rates over the remaining term of the Swap Agreement, the forecasted market rate interest payments had effectively converted to fixed rate interest payments making the Swap Agreement both ineffective and the underlying hedged cash flow no longer probable. Therefore, during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, we reclassified to interest expense the remaining $3.1 million of deferred losses recorded to accumulated other comprehensive loss and all subsequent changes in fair market value were recorded directly to earnings. For fiscal 2009, we reduced interest expense by $2.6 million as a result of the changes in fair value of the hedge and we reclassified $4.8 million into earnings as a result of the discontinuance of the hedge designation of the Swap Agreement. During fiscal 2010, we reduced interest expense by $1.2 million as a result of the changes in fair value of the hedge.

Embedded Derivative Bifurcated From Convertible Preferred Stock (See Note 12)

The terms of the Convertible Preferred Stock include a default dividend rate of 3% per annum if we fail to (1) pay holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, in cash on an as-converted basis, dividends paid on shares of our

 

110


Table of Contents

Common Stock; (2) following the date that there are no Convertible Notes outstanding, as defined in the Certificate of Designations, pay, in cash or kind, any dividend (other than dividends payable pursuant to the preceding clause (1)) payable to holders of Preferred Shares pursuant to the Certificate of Designations, on the applicable quarterly dividend payment date; (3) after June 30, 2010, reserve and keep available for issuance the number of shares of our Common Stock equal to 110% of the number of shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of all outstanding shares of Convertible Preferred Stock; (4) maintain the listing of our Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange or another U.S. national securities exchange; (5) comply with our obligations to convert the Convertible Preferred Stock in accordance with our obligations under the Certificate of Designations; (6) redeem Convertible Preferred Stock in compliance with the Certificate of Designations; or (7) comply with any dividend payment restrictions with respect to junior securities dividends. If, at a time when a 3% per annum default dividend rate is in effect after June 30, 2011, we fail to reserve and keep available authorized common shares pursuant to the terms of the Certificate of Designations the default dividend rate shall increase to 6% until such default is no longer continuing. The default dividend represents an embedded derivative which is bifurcated from the CD&R Equity Investment host contract (i.e., the Certificate of Designations). See Note 12 — Series B Cumulative Convertible Participating Preferred Stock for further discussion of the Convertible Preferred Stock.

To determine the Level 3 fair value of the embedded derivative, we used a probability-weighted discounted cash flow model and assigned probabilities for each qualified default event. We originally recorded the fair value of the embedded derivative in the amount of $1.0 million at November 1, 2009 in other accrued liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheet. The majority of the value of the derivative was derived from the default dividend rate. As discussed further in Note 12, on December 14, 2009, the CD&R Funds, our majority equity holders expressed their intention to vote in favor of the proposed Reverse Stock Split, which became effective on March 5, 2010. Based upon these events, we reevaluated the assigned probabilities used previously in the probability-weighted discounted cash flow model. As a result, we have recorded a $0.9 million decrease in fair value of the embedded derivative during fiscal 2010 which was recorded in other income and expense during the fiscal year.

At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the fair value carrying amount of our derivative instrument was recorded as follows (in thousands):

 

     Asset Derivative  

Derivative designated as hedging

instrument under ASC 815:

   Balance Sheet Location      October 30, 2011
Fair Value
     October 31, 2010
Fair Value
 

Foreign currency contracts

     Prepaid expenses and other       $ 42       $ —     

At October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the fair value carrying amount of our derivative instrument was recorded as follows (in thousands):

 

     Liability Derivative  

Derivative not designated as hedging

instruments under ASC 815:

   Balance Sheet Location      October 30, 2011
Fair Value
     October 31, 2010
Fair Value
 

Embedded derivative

     Other long-term liabilities       $ 79       $ 104   

The effect of derivative instruments on the Consolidated Statement of Operations for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010 was as follows (in thousands):

 

     Amount of (Loss) Gain Recognized
in OCI on Derivative
(Effective Portion)
 

Derivatives in ASC 815 Cash

Flow Hedging Relationship

   October 30, 2011      October 31, 2010  
     

Foreign currency contracts

   $ 5       $ —     

 

111


Table of Contents
     Amount of Loss  Recognized
in Income (Loss) on Derivative
      

Derivatives Not Designated as
Hedging

Instruments Under ASC 815

   October 30, 2011      October 31, 2010      Location of Loss Recognized  in
Income (Loss) on Derivative

Interest rate contract

   $ ––       $ 2,208       Interest expense

Embedded derivative

   $ 25       $ 937       Other income, net

The maximum length of time over which we are hedging our exposure to the variability of future cash flows related to fluctuations in the foreign currency exchange rates on certain purchase orders denominated in a foreign currency is through August 2012. Over the next 12 months, we expect to reclassify an immaterial amount of deferred gains from accumulated other comprehensive income to depreciation expense. We will recognize depreciation expense over the depreciable life of the fixed asset to which the purchase orders relate.

16. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents, trade accounts receivable and accounts payable approximate fair value as of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010 because of the relatively short maturity of these instruments. The fair values of the remaining financial instruments not currently recognized at fair value on our Consolidated Balance Sheets at the respective fiscal year ends were:

 

     October 30, 2011      October 31, 2010  
     Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value      Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value  
     (In thousands)      (In thousands)  

Amended Credit Agreement

   $ 130,699       $ 127,106       $ 136,305       $ 132,046   

The fair value of each of the Amended Credit Agreement was based on recent trading activities of comparable market instruments.

Fair Value Measurements

On May 2, 2010, we adopted ASU No. 2010-06, Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements. This update amended FASB ASC 820-10-50 to require new disclosures concerning (1) transfers into and out of Levels 1 and 2 of the fair value measurement hierarchy, and (2) activity in Level 3 measurements. In addition, this update clarified certain existing disclosure requirements regarding the level of disaggregation and inputs and valuation techniques. Finally, this update made conforming amendments to the guidance on employers’ disclosures about postretirement benefit plan assets.

ASC 820-10 requires us to use valuation techniques to measure fair value that maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. These inputs are prioritized as follows:

Level 1: Observable inputs such as quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in active markets.

Level 2: Other inputs that are observable directly or indirectly, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities or market-corroborated inputs.

Level 3: Unobservable inputs for which there is little or no market data and which require us to develop our own assumptions about how market participants would price the assets or liabilities.

The following is a description of the valuation methodologies used for assets and liabilities measured at fair value. There have been no changes in the methodologies used at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010.

 

112


Table of Contents

Money market: Money market funds have original maturities of three months or less. The original cost of these assets approximates fair value due to their short-term maturity.

Mutual funds: Mutual funds are valued at the closing price reported in the active market in which the mutual fund is traded.

Stocks, options and ETF’s: Stocks, options and ETF’s are valued at the closing price reported in the active market in which the fund is traded.

Foreign currency contracts: The fair value of the foreign currency derivative is based on a market approach and takes into consideration current foreign currency exchange rates and current creditworthiness of us or the counterparty, as applicable.

Assets held for sale: Assets held for sale are valued based on current market conditions, prices of similar assets in similar condition and expected proceeds from the sale of the assets.

Deferred compensation plan liability: Deferred compensation plan liability comprises of phantom investments in the deferred compensation plan and is valued at the closing price reported in the active market in which the money market, mutual fund or NCI stock phantom investments are traded.

Embedded derivative: The embedded derivative value is based on an income approach in which we used a probability-weighted discounted cash flow model and assigned probabilities for each qualified default event.

The following table summarizes information regarding our financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of October 30, 2011, segregated by level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value (in thousands):

 

     Level 1      Level 2     Level 3     Total  

Assets:

         

Short-term investments in deferred compensation plan(1):

         

Money market

   $ 149         —          —          149   

Mutual funds — Growth

     682         —          —          682   

Mutual funds — Blend

     1,798         —          —          1,798   

Mutual funds — Foreign blend

     743         —          —          743   

Mutual funds — Fixed income

     ––           638        —          638   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total short-term investments in deferred compensation plan

     3,372         638        —          4,010   

Other investments:

         

Cash

     45         —          —          45   

Stocks, options and ETF’s

     428         —          —          428   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other investments

     473         —          —          473   

Foreign currency contracts

     —           42        ––          42   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 3,845         680        —          4,525   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities:

         

Deferred compensation plan liability

   $ —           (4,077     —          (4,077

Embedded derivative

     —           —          (79     (79
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ —           (4,077     (79     (4,156
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

(1) Unrealized holding gains (losses) for the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009 were $(0.1) million, $0.4 million and $0.9 million, respectively.

 

113


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes information regarding our financial assets that are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis as of October 30, 2011, segregated by level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value (in thousands):

 

     Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Assets:

           

Assets held for sale(1)

   $ —           —           2,500         2,500   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ —           —           2,500         2,500   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Certain assets held for sale are valued at fair value and are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis. Assets held for sale are reported at fair value, if, on an individual basis, the fair value of the asset is less than cost. The fair value of assets held for sale is estimated using Level 3 inputs, such as broker quotes for like-kind assets or other market indications of a potential selling value which approximates fair value. As of October 30, 2011, the fair value of one asset group held for sale exceeded that asset group’s cost and carrying value. Accordingly, that asset group held for sale has been excluded from the table as of October 30, 2011.

The following table summarizes information regarding our financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of October 31, 2010, segregated by level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value (in thousands):

 

     Level 1     Level 2      Level 3     Total  

Assets:

         

Short-term investments in deferred compensation plan:

         

Money market

   $ 366        —           —          366   

Mutual funds — Growth

     394        —           —          394   

Mutual funds — Blend

     1,595        —           —          1,595   

Mutual funds — Foreign blend

     637        —           —          637   

Mutual funds — Fixed income

     746        —           —          746   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total short-term investments in deferred compensation plan

     3,738        —           —          3,738   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 3,738        —           —          3,738   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities:

         

Deferred compensation plan liability

   $ (3,920     —           —          (3,920

Embedded derivative

     —          —           (104     (104
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ (3,920     —           (104     (4,024
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table summarizes information regarding our financial assets that are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis as of October 31, 2010, segregated by level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value (in thousands):

 

     Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Assets:

           

Assets held for sale(1)

   $ —           —           3,740         3,740   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ —           —           3,740         3,740   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Certain assets held for sale are valued at fair value and are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis. Assets held for sale are reported at fair value, if, on an individual basis, the fair value of the asset is less than cost. The fair value of assets held for sale is estimated using Level 3 inputs, such as broker quotes for like-kind assets or other market indications of a potential selling value which approximates fair value. As of October 31, 2010, the fair value of one asset group held for sale exceeded that asset group’s cost and carrying value. Accordingly, that asset group held for sale has been excluded from the table as of October 31, 2010.

 

114


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the activity in Level 3 financial instruments during fiscal 2011 and 2010:

 

     Embedded
derivative
 

Balance at November 1, 2009

   $ (1,041

Unrealized gains(1)

     937   
  

 

 

 

Balance at October 31, 2010

   $ (104

Unrealized gains(1)

     25   
  

 

 

 

Balance at October 30, 2011

   $ (79
  

 

 

 

 

(1) Unrealized gains on the embedded derivative are recorded net in other income in the Consolidated Statements of Operations during the fiscal year ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009.

17. INCOME TAXES

Income tax expense is based on pretax financial accounting income. Deferred income taxes are recognized for the temporary differences between the recorded amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and such amounts for income tax purposes. The income tax benefit for the fiscal years ended 2011, 2010 and 2009, consisted of the following (in thousands):

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 

Current:

      

Federal

   $ 207      $ (15,506   $ (28,706

State

     (312     2,133        (1,366
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current

     (105     (13,373     (30,072

Deferred:

      

Federal

     (6,183     123        (23,545

State

     (109     (80     (3,296
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred

     (6,292     43        (26,841
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total benefit

   $ (6,397   $ (13,330   $ (56,913
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The reconciliation of income tax computed at the United States federal statutory tax rate to the effective income tax rate is as follows:

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 

Statutory federal income tax rate

     35.0     35.0     35.0

State income taxes

     4.0     1.5     3.3

Non-deductible goodwill impairment

     —          —          (27.0 )% 

Canadian valuation allowance

     1.2     0.1     (0.1 )% 

Non-deductible interest expense

     —          —          (0.2 )% 

Production activities deduction

     ––          (2.5 )%      —     

Premium on Convertible Notes exchange offer

     —          —          (4.1 )% 

Recognition of tax benefit previously deemed to be uncertain

      

Other

     (1.1 )%      (0.9 )%      0.1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective tax rate

     39.1     33.2     7.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

115


Table of Contents

Deferred income taxes reflect the net impact of temporary differences between the amounts of assets and liabilities recognized for financial reporting purposes and such amounts recognized for income tax purposes. The tax effects of the temporary differences for fiscal 2011 and 2010 are as follows (in thousands):

 

     As of
October 30,
2011
    As of
October 31,
2010
 

Deferred tax assets:

    

Inventory obsolescence

   $ 968      $ 969   

Bad debt reserve

     1,665        1,128   

Accrued and deferred compensation

     13,677        11,755   

Accrued insurance reserves

     1,820        1,446   

Deferred revenue

     7,453        7,340   

Net operating loss carryover

     11,166        6,936   

Depreciation and amortization

     266        530   

Deferred financing costs

     1,380        1,924   

Pension

     3,777        1,574   

Other reserves

     163        41   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

     42,335        33,643   

Less valuation allowance

     (5,417     (5,192
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

     36,918        28,451   

Deferred tax liabilities:

    

Depreciation and amortization

     (22,482     (23,022

Pension

     —          —     

Other

     (1,344     (1,275
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

     (23,826     (24,297
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax asset

   $ 13,092      $ 4,154   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

We carry out our business operations through legal entities in the U.S., Canada and Mexico. These operations require that we file corporate income tax returns that are subject to U.S., state and foreign tax laws. We are subject to income tax audits in these multiple jurisdictions.

As of October 30, 2011, the $11.2 million net operating loss carryforward consisted of $5.1 million for foreign loss carryforward, $4.0 million for U.S. federal loss carryforward and $2.1 million for U.S. state loss carryforward. The U.S. federal net operating loss carried forward is the fiscal 2011 taxable loss which is approximately $10.3 million and represents $4.0 million of deferred tax asset. This loss will expire, if unused, by fiscal 2031. As of October 30, 2011, we have deferred tax assets of $2.1 million related to state net operating loss carryforwards which will expire in 3 to 20 years, if unused.

We expect to generate sufficient operating profits in future periods to fully utilize our net deferred tax assets of $13.1 million. In evaluating our expectations, we have evaluated a variety of factors including multiple industry sources citing continued growth in the nonresidential construction market into 2012 and 2013, our continued market strength in the commercial and industrial subsectors of the nonresidential market that are experiencing growth above that of the overall nonresidential construction market and our internal forecast projections which we believe will continue the profitable trends experienced in the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2011. Our expectations could change in the near term if nonresidential construction fails to continue its projected recovery. In the event our operating results or expectations of future operating results change, a valuation allowance may be required on our existing unreserved net U.S. deferred tax assets.

As of October 30, 2011, our foreign operations have a net operating loss carryforward of approximately $17.6 million, representing $5.1 million of the $11.2 million deferred tax asset related to net operating loss carryovers, that will start to expire in fiscal 2025, if unused. The utilization of these foreign losses is uncertain

 

116


Table of Contents

and we currently have a full valuation allowance against the deferred tax asset related to this loss carryforward. The following table represents the rollforward of the valuation allowance on deferred taxes activity for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011, October 31, 2010 and November 1, 2009 (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
     October 31,
2010
     November 1,
2009
 

Beginning balance

   $ 5,192       $ 5,018       $ 4,972   

Additions

     225         174         46   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 5,417       $ 5,192       $ 5,018   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Uncertain tax positions

The total amount of unrecognized tax benefits at October 30, 2011 was $0.3 million, of which $0.3 million would impact the Company’s effective tax rate, if recognized. The total amount of unrecognized tax benefit at October 31, 2010 was $0.5 million, of which $0.5 million would impact the Company’s effective tax rate if recognized. We do not anticipate any material change in the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits to occur within the next twelve months.

The following table summarizes the activity related to the Company’s unrecognized tax benefits during fiscal 2011 and 2010 (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Unrecognized tax benefits at beginning of year

   $ 462      $ 685   

Additions for tax positions related to prior years

     19        29   

Reductions due to lapse of applicable statute of limitations

     (209     (252
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unrecognized tax benefits at end of year

   $ 272      $ 462   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

We recognize interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in income tax expense. To the extent accrued interest and penalties do not ultimately become payable, amounts accrued will be reduced and reflected as a reduction of the overall income tax provision in the period that such determination is made. We did not have a material amount of accrued interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions as of October 30, 2011.

We file income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction and multiple state and foreign jurisdictions. The Internal Revenue Service is currently auditing our income tax returns for the 2008, 2009 and 2010 fiscal years. Our tax years are closed with the IRS through the year ended October 28, 2007 as the statute of limitations related to these tax years has closed. In addition, open tax years related to state and foreign jurisdictions remain subject to examination but are not considered material.

18. ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

Accumulated other comprehensive loss consists of the following (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Foreign exchange translation adjustments, net of tax

   $ 568      $ 587   

Defined benefit pension plan, net of tax

     (6,058     (2,524

Foreign currency derivative, net of tax

     5        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

   $ (5,485   $ (1,937
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

117


Table of Contents

19. SUPPLEMENTARY CASH FLOW INFORMATION

The following table sets forth interest paid, taxes paid and non-cash dividends and accretion in each of the three fiscal years presented (in thousands):

 

     Fiscal Year Ended  
     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
    November 1,
2009
 

Interest paid, net of amounts capitalized

   $ 11,059      $ 13,683      $ 18,445   

Taxes paid (refunded)

     (14,519     (26,332     5,645   

Non-cash dividends and accretion

     (17,080     (34,055     —     

In October 2009, we completed an exchange offer to acquire our existing $180 million aggregate principal amount 2.125% convertible senior subordinated notes due 2024 (the “Convertible Notes”) in exchange for a combination of $500 in cash and 78 shares of NCI common stock for each $1,000 of Convertible Notes tendered and not withdrawn, with approximately 99.9% of the outstanding Convertible Notes tendered and not withdrawn as of the expiration of the offer and by which we subsequently accepted. This resulted in a non-cash reclassification from long-term debt to stockholders’ equity on our consolidated balance sheet as we issued approximately 14.0 million shares. See further discussion of these Convertible Notes in Note 11 — Long-term Debt and Note Payable.

The dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accrue and accumulate on a daily basis and are included in the liquidation preference. Accrued dividends are recorded into Convertible Preferred Stock on the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheet. Dividends are accrued at the 12% paid in-kind rate and increased the Convertible Preferred Stock by $14.4 million and $31.4 million during fiscal 2011 and 2010, respectively.

20. OPERATING LEASE COMMITMENTS

We have operating lease commitments expiring at various dates, principally for real estate, office space, office equipment and transportation equipment. Certain of these operating leases have purchase options that entitle us to purchase the respective equipment at fair value at the end of the lease. In addition, many of our leases contain renewal options at rates similar to the current arrangements. As of October 30, 2011, future minimum rental payments related to noncancellable operating leases are as follows (in thousands):

 

2012

   $  3,560   

2013

     2,082   

2014

     1,033   

2015

     598   

2016

     498   

Thereafter

     829   

Rental expense incurred from operating leases, including leases with terms of less than one year, for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $10.0 million, $10.3 million and $11.9 million, respectively.

21. STOCK REPURCHASE PROGRAM

Our board of directors has authorized a stock repurchase program. Subject to applicable federal securities law, such purchases occur at times and in amounts that we deem appropriate. Shares repurchased are used primarily for later re-issuance in connection with our equity incentive and 401(k) profit sharing plans. Although we did not repurchase any shares of our common stock during fiscal 2011 and 2010, we did withhold shares of restricted stock to satisfy tax withholding obligations arising in connection with the vesting of awards of restricted stock, which are included in treasury stock purchases in the Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’

 

118


Table of Contents

Equity. At October 30, 2011, there were 0.1 million shares remaining authorized for repurchase under the program. While there is no time limit on the duration of the program, our Amended Credit Agreement and ABL Facility apply certain limitations on our repurchase of shares of our common stock.

Changes in treasury common stock, at cost, were as follows (in thousands):

 

     Number of
Shares
    Amount  

Balance, November 1, 2009

     —        $ —     

Purchases

     0        381   

Retirements

     (0     (381
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, October 31, 2010

     —        $ —     

Purchases

     124        1,477   

Retirements

     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, October 30, 2011

     124      $ 1,477   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

22. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

Defined Contribution Plan — We have a 401(k) profit sharing plan (the “Savings Plan”) that allows participation for all eligible employees. The Savings Plan allows us to match employee contributions up to 6% of a participant’s pre-tax deferral of eligible compensation into the plan. On February 27, 2009, the Savings Plan was amended, effective January 1, 2009, to make the matching contributions fully discretionary, and matching contributions were temporarily suspended. Effective July 1, 2011, the matching contributions to the Savings Plan were resumed and allowed us the discretion to match between 50% and 100% of the participant’s contributions up to 6% of a participant’s pre-tax deferrals, based on a calculation of the Company’s annual return-on-assets. Contributions expense for the fiscal years ended October 30, 2011 and November 1, 2009 were $0.7 million and $0.8 million, respectively, for matching contributions to the Savings Plan. No matching contributions were made to the Savings Plan during fiscal 2010.

As a result of the economic downturn and restructuring, we have determined our Savings Plan has experienced a partial plan termination which, as defined by the IRS, is a significant reduction in the workforce. As a result, the affected employee participants of the Savings Plan become fully vested in company-matching contributions upon termination. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the impact of this partial plan termination was immaterial, excluding the impact of the employer contributions.

Deferred Compensation Plan — On October 23, 2006, the board of directors approved an Amended and Restated Deferred Compensation Plan for NCI (as amended and restated, the “Deferred Compensation Plan”) effective for compensation beginning in calendar 2007. The Deferred Compensation Plan allows our officers and key employees to defer up to 80% of their annual salary and up to 90% of their bonus on a pre-tax basis until a specified date in the future, including at or after retirement. Additionally, the Deferred Compensation Plan allows our directors to defer up to 100% of their annual fees and meeting attendance fees until a specified date in the future, including at or after retirement. The Deferred Compensation Plan also permits us to make contributions on behalf of our key employees who are impacted by the federal tax compensation limits under the NCI 401(k) plan, and to receive a restoration matching amount which, under the current NCI 401(k) terms, mirrors our 401(k) profit sharing plan matching levels based on our Company’s performance. On February 27, 2009, restoration matching contributions were indefinitely suspended, effective January 1, 2009. Effective July 1, 2011, the restoration match for the deferred compensation plan resumed. In addition, the Deferred Compensation Plan provides for us to make discretionary contributions to employees who have elected to defer compensation under the plan. Deferred Compensation Plan participants will vest in our discretionary contributions ratably over three years from the date of each of our discretionary contributions. Any unvested matching contributions in a

 

119


Table of Contents

participant’s Deferred Compensation Plan account became vested upon consummation of the Equity Investment on October 20, 2009. In addition, the Deferred Compensation Plan also permitted participants to have their account balances paid out upon a change of control which reduced the rabbi trust assets and corresponding liability by $2.6 million on October 28, 2009. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the liability balance of the Deferred Compensation Plan is $4.1 million and $3.9 million, respectively, and is included in accrued compensation and benefits in the Consolidated Balance Sheet. We have not made any discretionary contributions to the Deferred Compensation Plan.

With the Deferred Compensation Plan, the Board also approved the establishment of a rabbi trust to fund the Deferred Compensation Plan and the formation of an administrative committee to manage the Deferred Compensation Plan and its assets. The investments in the rabbi trust are $4.0 million and $3.7 million at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, respectively. The rabbi trust investments include debt and equity securities, along with cash equivalents and are accounted for as trading securities.

Defined Benefit Plan — As a result of the closing of the RCC acquisition on April 7, 2006, we assumed a defined benefit plan (the “RCC Pension Plan”). Benefits under the RCC Pension Plan are primarily based on years of service and the employee’s compensation. The RCC Pension Plan is frozen and, therefore, employees do not accrue additional service benefits. Plan assets of the RCC Pension Plan are invested in broadly diversified portfolios of government obligations, hedge funds, mutual funds, stocks, bonds and fixed income securities. In accordance with ASC 805, we quantified the projected benefit obligation and fair value of the plan assets of the RCC Pension Plan and recorded the difference between these two amounts as an assumed liability.

As a result of the economic downturn and restructuring, we have determined our RCC Pension Plan has experienced a partial plan termination, defined by the IRS as a significant reduction in force. As a result, the affected employee participants become fully vested upon termination. However, the RCC Pension Plan is frozen, therefore, accrued benefits are already fully vested. As of October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, the impact of this partial plan termination was immaterial.

Defined Benefit Plans Adoption. On October 31, 2010, we adopted ASC Subtopic 715-20, Defined Benefit Plans — General (“ASC 715-20”). This statement provides guidance on an employer’s disclosures about plan assets of a defined benefit pension or other postretirement plan. We adopted the disclosure provisions required by ASC 715-20 in fiscal 2010 but are not required to implement the disclosures for earlier periods presented for comparative purposes.

The following table reconciles the change in the benefit obligation for the RCC Pension Plan from the beginning of the fiscal year to the end of the fiscal year (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Accumulated benefit obligation

   $ 48,207      $ 44,697   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Projected benefit obligation — beginning of fiscal year

   $ 44,697      $ 46,091   

Interest cost

     2,020        2,534   

Benefit payments

     (3,413     (4,165

Actuarial losses

     4,903        237   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Projected benefit obligation — end of fiscal year

   $ 48,207      $ 44,697   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Actuarial assumptions used to determine benefit obligations were as follows:

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Assumed discount rate

     4.35     4.75

 

120


Table of Contents

The following table reconciles the change in plan assets of the RCC Pension Plan from the beginning of the fiscal year to the end of the fiscal year (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Fair value of assets — beginning of fiscal year

   $ 39,981      $ 39,474   

Actual return on plan assets

     1,544        4,672   

Company contributions

     93        —     

Benefit payments

     (3,413     (4,165
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fair value of assets — end of fiscal year

   $ 38,205      $ 39,981   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table sets forth the funded status of the RCC Pension Plan and the amounts recognized in the Consolidated Balance Sheet (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Fair value of assets

   $ 38,205      $ 39,981   

Benefit obligation

     48,207        44,697   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Funded status

   $ (10,002   $ (4,716

Unrecognized actuarial loss

     9,912        4,186   

Unrecognized prior service cost

     (78     (87
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accrued benefit cost

   $ (168   $ (617
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income that have not yet been recognized as components of net periodic benefit income (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Unrecognized actuarial loss

     9,912        4,186   

Unrecognized prior service cost

     (78     (87
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 9,834      $ 4,099   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table sets forth the components of the net periodic benefit income (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Interest cost

   $ 2,020      $ 2,534   

Expected return on assets

     (2,368     (2,363

Amortization of prior service cost

     (9     (9

Amortization of loss

     —          171   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net periodic benefit cost (income)

   $ (357   $ 333   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table sets forth the changes in plan assets and benefit obligation recognized in other comprehensive income (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
     October 31,
2010
 

Net actuarial loss (gain)

   $ 5,727       $ (2,071

Amortization of net actuarial loss

     —           (171

Amortization of prior service credit

     9         9   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total recognized in other comprehensive income (loss)

   $ 5,736       $ (2,233
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

121


Table of Contents

The estimated amortization payments for the next fiscal year for amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income into the consolidated income statement (in thousands):

 

     October 30,
2011
 

Amortization of prior service cost

     (9

Amortization of loss

     641   
  

 

 

 

Total estimated amortized payments

   $ 632   
  

 

 

 

Actuarial assumptions used to determine net periodic benefit income were as follows:

 

     Fiscal 2011     Fiscal 2010  

Assumed discount rate

     4.75     5.75

Expected rate of return on plan assets

     7.0     7.0

The basis used to determine the overall expected long-term asset return assumption was a ten year forecast of expected return based on the target asset allocation for the plan. The expected return for this portfolio over the forecast period is 7.0%, net of investment related expenses. In determining the expected return over the forecast period, we used a 10-year median expected return, taking into consideration historical experience, anticipated asset allocations, investment strategies and the views of various investment professionals.

The weighted-average asset allocations by asset category are as follows:

 

Investment Type

   October 30,
2011
    October 31,
2010
 

Equity securities

     28     28

Debt securities

     47        42   

Hedge funds

     8        13   

Cash and cash equivalents

     5        1   

Real estate

     4        5   

Other

     8        11   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100     100
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The investment policy is to maximize the expected return for an acceptable level of risk. Our expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is based on a target allocation of assets, which is based on our goal of earning the highest rate of return while maintaining risk at acceptable levels. The RCC Pension Plan strives to have assets sufficiently diversified so that adverse or unexpected results from one security class will not have an unduly detrimental impact on the entire portfolio. We regularly review our actual asset allocation and the RCC Pension Plan’s investments are periodically rebalanced to our target allocation when considered appropriate. We have set the target asset allocation for the plan as follows: 44% US bonds, 13% alpha strategies (hedge funds), 16% large cap US equities, 5% small cap US equities, 4% real estate investment trusts, 8% foreign equity, 4% emerging markets and 6% commodity futures.

The table below presents the fair values of the assets in our RCC Pension Plan at October 30, 2011 and October 31, 2010, by asset category and by levels of fair value as further defined in Note 16 — Fair Value of Financial Instruments and Fair Value Measurements.

 

122


Table of Contents
     October 30, 2011  
     Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Asset category:

           

Cash

   $ 1,829         —           —           1,829   

Mutual funds:

           

Growth funds(1)

     1,337         —           —           1,337   

Real estate funds(2)

     1,619         —           —           1,619   

Commodity linked funds(3)

     2,036         —           —           2,036   

Government securities(4)

     —           10,694         —           10,694   

Corporate bonds(5)

     —           6,736         —           6,736   

Common/collective trusts(6)

     —           10,915         —           10,915   

Partnerships/Joint venture interest(7)

     —           —           3,039         3,039   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total as of October 30, 2011

   $ 6,821         28,345         3,039         38,205   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     October 31, 2010  
     Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total  

Asset category:

           

Cash

   $ 602         —           —           602   

Mutual funds:

           

Growth funds(1)

     1,848         —           —           1,848   

Real estate funds(2)

     1,863         —           —           1,863   

Commodity linked funds(3)

     2,452         —           —           2,452   

Government securities(4)

     —           9,827         —           9,827   

Corporate bonds(5)

     —           6,584         —           6,584   

Common/collective trusts(6)

     —           11,584         —           11,584   

Partnerships/Joint venture interest(7)

     —           —           5,221         5,221   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total as of October 31, 2010

   $ 6,765         27,995         5,221         39,981   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) The strategy seeks long-term growth of capital. The fund currently invests in common stocks and other securities of companies in countries with developing economies and/or markets.
(2) The portfolio is constructed of Real Estate Investment Trusts (“REITs”) with the potential to provide strong and consistent earnings growth. Eligible investments for the portfolio include publicly traded equity REITs, Real Estate Operating Companies, homebuilders and commercial REITs. The portfolio invests across various sectors and is geographically diverse to manage potential risk.
(3) The strategy seeks to replicate a diversified basket of commodity futures consistent with the composition of the Dow Jones UBS Commodity index. The strategy is defined to be a hedge against risking inflation and from time to time will allocate a portion of the portfolio to inflation-protected securities and other fixed income securities.
(4) These holdings represent fixed-income securities issued and backed by the full faith of the United States government. The strategy is designed to lengthen duration to match the duration of the pension plan liabilities.
(5) These holdings represent fixed-income securities with varying maturities diversified by issuer, sector and industry. At the time of purchase, the securities must be rated investment grade. This strategy is also taken into consideration with the government bond holdings when matching duration of the liabilities.
(6) The collective trusts seek long-term growth of capital through index replication strategies designed to match the holdings of the S&P 500, Russell 2000 and MSCI EAFE.
(7) The strategy seeks long-term growth of capital through a diversified hedge fund of fund offering. The hedge fund of fund will be diversified by strategy and firm seeking bond-like volatility over a full market cycle. When observable prices are not available for these securities, the value is based on a market approach, as defined in the authoritative guidance on fair value measurements, to evaluate the fair value of such Level 3 instruments.

 

123


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the fair value activity of partnerships/joint venture interest in the RCC Pension Plan in Level 3 during fiscal 2011:

 

     October 30,
2011
 

Beginning balance

   $ 5,221   

Purchases, sales and settlements, net

     (2,250

Actual return on plan assets

     68   
  

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 3,039   
  

 

 

 

We expect to contribute $1,607,000 to the RCC Pension Plan in fiscal 2012.

We expect the following benefit payments to be made (in thousands):

 

Fiscal Years Ended

   Pension
Benefits
 

2012

   $ 4,015   

2013

     3,831   

2014

     3,860   

2015

     3,632   

2016

     3,524   

2017-2020

     16,975   

23. BUSINESS SEGMENTS

We have aggregated our operations into three reportable segments based upon similarities in product lines, manufacturing processes, marketing and management of our businesses: metal coil coating; metal components; and engineered building systems. All business segments operate primarily in the nonresidential construction market. Sales and earnings are influenced by general economic conditions, the level of nonresidential construction activity, metal roof repair and retrofit demand and the availability and terms of financing available for construction. Products of our business segments use similar basic raw materials. The metal coil coating segment consists of cleaning, treating, painting and slitting continuous steel coils before the steel is fabricated for use by construction and industrial users. The metal components segment products include metal roof and wall panels, doors, metal partitions, metal trim, insulated panels and other related accessories. The engineered building systems segment includes the manufacturing of main frames, Long Bay® Systems and value-added engineering and drafting, which are typically not part of metal components or metal coil coating products or services. The reporting segments follow the same accounting policies used for our Consolidated Financial Statements.

We evaluate a segment’s performance based primarily upon operating income before corporate expenses. Intersegment sales are recorded based on standard material costs plus a standard markup to cover labor and overhead and consist of (i) hot-rolled, light gauge painted and slit material and other services provided by the metal coil coating segment to both the metal components and engineered building systems segments; (ii) building components provided by the metal components segment to the engineered building systems segment; and (iii) structural framing provided by the engineered building systems segment to the metal components segment.

Corporate assets consist primarily of cash but also include deferred financing costs, deferred taxes and property, plant and equipment associated with our headquarters in Houston, Texas. These items (and income and expenses related to these items) are not allocated to the business segments. Unallocated expenses include interest income, interest expense, debt extinguishment and refinancing costs and other (expense) income.

 

124


Table of Contents

The following table represents summary financial data attributable to these business segments for the periods indicated (in thousands):

 

     2011     2010     2009  

Total sales:

      

Metal coil coating

   $ 201,098      $ 181,874      $ 169,897   

Metal components

     437,655        415,857        458,734   

Engineered building systems

     548,594        490,746        538,938   

Intersegment sales

     (227,770     (217,951     (202,317
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net sales

   $ 959,577      $ 870,526      $ 965,252   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

External sales:

      

Metal coil coating

   $ 75,394      $ 65,240      $ 53,189   

Metal components

     353,797        328,077        389,132   

Engineered building systems

     530,386        477,209        522,931   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net sales

   $ 959,577      $ 870,526      $ 965,252   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss):

      

Metal coil coating

   $ 17,944      $ 16,166      $ (99,689

Metal components

     20,643        26,791        (130,039

Engineered building systems

     13,011        (18,438     (389,007

Corporate

     (53,225     (49,106     (64,583
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating income (loss)

   $ (1,627   $ (24,587   $ (683,318

Unallocated other expense

     (14,720     (15,620     (124,391
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

   $ (16,347   $ (40,207   $ (807,709
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization:

      

Metal coil coating

   $ 4,647      $ 5,242      $ 5,483   

Metal components

     8,986        9,130        9,299   

Engineered building systems

     13,161        13,701        14,838   

Corporate

     6,420        6,431        3,911   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total depreciation and amortization expense

   $ 33,214      $ 34,504      $ 33,531   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Capital expenditures:

      

Metal coil coating

   $ 1,431      $ 6,308      $ 1,865   

Metal components

     13,017        3,830        14,726   

Engineered building systems

     2,847        1,328        1,347   

Corporate

     3,745        2,564        3,719   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capital expenditures

   $ 21,040      $ 14,030      $ 21,657   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, net:

      

Metal coil coating

   $ 34,771      $ 37,229     

Metal components

     87,664        83,807     

Engineered building systems

     59,546        66,078     

Corporate

     26,533        27,339     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

Total property, plant and equipment, net

   $ 208,514      $ 214,453     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

Total assets as of fiscal year end 2011 and 2010:

      

Metal coil coating

   $ 55,509      $ 57,137     

Metal components

     175,906        167,542     

Engineered building systems

     206,232        208,232     

Corporate

     123,507        127,613     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   
   $ 561,154      $ 560,524     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

125


Table of Contents

24. CONTINGENCIES

We were engaged in a lawsuit that was originally filed by us on August 8, 2008 in state district court in Houston, Texas, with one of our direct customers and 14 of its end-user customers regarding alleged leaks from our roofing panels. We sought to recover approximately $0.4 million owed for materials that were delivered to our direct customer as well as attorneys’ fees and expenses in the lawsuit. In response to the lawsuit, our direct customer asserted various counterclaims and that it was entitled to actual damages in the amount of approximately $3.2 million plus attorneys’ fees and punitive damages. During fiscal 2010 and into the first quarter of fiscal 2011, the end-users of our roofing panels intervened in the lawsuit and asserted various claims against us and that they were collectively entitled to actual damages in the amount of approximately $12 million plus attorneys’ fees and punitive damages.

Trial began on July 5, 2011 and concluded on July 21, 2011. On July 22, 2011, a jury returned a verdict on all counts in favor of the Company. Additionally, the jury found in favor of the Company on our direct customer’s claims for breach of contract, breach of implied warranties, fraud, violations of the Texas Deceptive Trade Practices Act, tortious interference, business disparagement, strict products liability, and negligent design, manufacture and marketing. Further, the jury found in favor of the Company on the end-users’ claims for breach of implied warranties, violations of the Texas Deceptive Trade Practices Act, strict products liability and negligent design, manufacturing and marketing. On August 26, 2011, the district court judge entered final judgment against our direct customer awarding the Company approximately (i) $0.4 million owed for materials that were delivered but not paid by our direct customer, (ii) approximately $0.3 million in attorneys’ fees, (iii) approximately $0.2 million in prejudgment interest, and (iv) up to $0.125 million in the event this lawsuit is appealed. A notice of appeal was filed by our direct customer on October 12, 2011.

As a manufacturer of products primarily for use in nonresidential building construction, we are inherently exposed to various types of contingent claims, both asserted and unasserted, in the ordinary course of business. As a result, from time to time, we and/or our subsidiaries become involved in various legal proceedings or other contingent matters arising from claims, or potential claims. We insure against these risks to the extent deemed prudent by our management and to the extent insurance is available. Many of these insurance policies contain deductibles or self-insured retentions in amounts we deem prudent and for which we are responsible for payment. In determining the amount of self-insurance, it is our policy to self-insure those losses that are predictable, measurable and recurring in nature, such as claims for automobile liability, general liability and workers compensation. The Company regularly reviews the status of on-going proceedings and other contingent matters along with legal counsel. Liabilities for such items are recorded when it is probable that the liability has been incurred and when the amount of the liability can be reasonably estimated. Liabilities are adjusted when additional information becomes available. Management believes that the ultimate disposition of these matters will not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s operations or financial position taken as a whole.

 

126


Table of Contents

25. QUARTERLY RESULTS (Unaudited)

Shown below are selected unaudited quarterly data (in thousands, except per share data):

 

     First
Quarter
    Second
Quarter
    Third
Quarter
    Fourth
Quarter
 

FISCAL YEAR 2011

        

Sales

   $ 190,086      $ 225,565      $ 262,138      $ 281,788   

Gross profit

   $ 33,545      $ 50,813      $ 56,883      $ 59,192   

Net income (loss)

   $ (12,725   $ (3,229   $ 2,593      $ 3,411   

Net loss applicable to common shares(2)

   $ (20,741   $ (9,249   $ (13,077   $ (4,399

Loss per common share:(1)

        

Basic

   $ (1.14   $ (0.51   $ (0.71   $ (0.24

Diluted

   $ (1.14   $ (0.51   $ (0.71   $ (0.24

FISCAL YEAR 2010

        

Sales

   $ 182,207      $ 201,573      $ 245,292      $ 241,454   

Gross profit

   $ 32,438      $ 40,663      $ 50,357      $ 46,357   

Net loss

   $ (10,486   $ (7,656   $ (3,299   $ (5,436

Net loss applicable to common shares(3)

   $ (18,807   $ (257,345   $ (16,519   $ (18,556

Loss per common share:(1)

        

Basic

   $ (1.04   $ (14.15   $ (0.90   $ (1.01

Diluted

   $ (1.04   $ (14.15   $ (0.90   $ (1.01

 

(1) The sum of the quarterly income per share amounts may not equal the annual amount reported, as per share amounts are computed independently for each quarter and for the full year based on the respective weighted average common shares outstanding.
(2) Included in net income (loss) applicable to common shares is the beneficial conversion feature of $1.8 million, $(0.2) million, $6.5 million and $1.4 million for the first, second, third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2011, respectively.
(3) Included in net income (loss) applicable to common shares is the beneficial conversion feature of $0.2 million, $241.3 million, $4.6 million and $4.2 million for the first, second, third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2010, respectively.

The quarterly income (loss) amounts were impacted by the following special income (expense) items:

 

     First
Quarter
    Second
Quarter
    Third
Quarter
    Fourth
Quarter
 

FISCAL YEAR 2011

        

Restructuring charges

   $ —        $ —        $ 575      $ (283

Asset (impairments) recovery

     —          —          93        (1,214

Pre-acquisition contingency adjustments

     (252     —          —          —     

Increase in actuarial determined general liability self-insurance reserve

     (1,101     (1,297     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total special charges in operating income (loss)

   $ (1,353   $ (1,297   $ 668      $ (1,497
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FISCAL YEAR 2010

        

Restructuring charges

   $ (524   $ (829   $ (551   $ (1,628

Asset (impairments) recovery

     (1,029     116        64        (221

Pre-acquisition contingency adjustments

     —          —          —          (178
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total special charges in operating income (loss)

   $ (1,553   $ (713   $ (487   $ (2,027
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

26. SUBSEQUENT EVENT

On December 9, 2011, we entered into a second Mutual Waiver and Consent with the CD&R Funds, under which (1) the CD&R Funds, as the holders of all of our issued and outstanding Convertible Preferred Stock,

 

127


Table of Contents

agreed to accept a paid-in-kind dividend on their Preferred Shares for the quarterly dividend payment period ended December 15, 2011 computed at the dividend rate of 8% per annum, rather than the dividend rate of 12% per annum provided for in the Certificate of Designations applicable to the Preferred Shares, and (2) the Company waived its right under the Stockholders Agreement with the CD&R Funds to issue up to $5 million of its capital stock without the consent of the CD&R Funds during the fiscal year ending October 28, 2012, subject to certain exceptions.

The December 9, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent does not extend to dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock accruing after December 15, 2011 or restrict our issuance of capital stock after October 28, 2012.

In view of the December 9, 2011 Mutual Waiver and Consent, the Dividend Payment Committee of the board of directors declared and directed the payment of the December 15, 2011 dividend on the Preferred Shares in-kind at the reduced rate of 8% per annum. As a result of accruing the dividend at the stated 12% rate, and subsequently agreeing to the lower 8% rate, the Company will record a dividend accrual reversal of $1.4 million in the first quarter of fiscal 2012 related to dividends accrued between September 16, 2011 and October 30, 2011. Similarly, the Company will record a beneficial conversion feature reversal of $0.5 million in the first quarter of fiscal 2012 related to beneficial conversion feature charges between September 16, 2011 and October 30, 2011.

On December 15, 2011, the Dividend Payment Committee of the board of directors declared and paid to the holders of Convertible Preferred Stock, the CD&R Funds, a dividend of 5,833.4913 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock for the period from September 16, 2011 to December 15, 2011.

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure.

None.

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures.

Our management, with the participation of our chief executive officer and chief financial officer, evaluated the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as of October 30, 2011. The term “disclosure controls and procedures,” as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act, means controls and other procedures of a company that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by a company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms. Disclosure controls and procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by a company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to the company’s management, including its principal executive and principal financial officers, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding the required disclosure. Management recognizes that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving their objectives and management necessarily applies its judgment in evaluating the cost-benefit relationship of possible controls and procedures. Management believes that our disclosure controls and procedures are designed to provide reasonable assurance of achieving their objectives and based on the evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures as of October 30, 2011, our chief executive officer and chief financial officer concluded that, as of such date, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective at such reasonable assurance level.

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting is included in the financial statement pages at page 70.

There has been no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) during the fiscal quarter ended October 30, 2011 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

Item 9B. Other Information.

None.

 

128


Table of Contents

PART III

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance.

We have adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, a copy of which is available on our website at www.ncilp.com under the heading “Corporate Governance — NCI Guidelines.” Any amendments to, or waivers from the Code of Business Conduct and Ethics that apply to our executive officers and directors will be posted on the “Corporate Governance — NCI Guidelines” section of our Internet web site located at www.ncilp.com. However, the information on our website is not incorporated by reference into this Form 10-K.

The information under the captions “Election of Directors,” “Management,” “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance,” “Board of Directors” and “Corporate Governance” in our definitive proxy statement for our annual meeting of shareholders to be held on February 23, 2012 is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 11. Executive Compensation.

The information under the captions “Compensation Discussion and Analysis,” “Report of the Compensation Committee” and “Executive Compensation” in our definitive proxy statement for our annual meeting of shareholders to be held on February 23, 2012 is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters.

The information under the captions “Outstanding Capital Stock” and “Securities Reserved for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans” in our definitive proxy statement for our annual meeting of shareholders to be held on February 23, 2012 is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence.

The information under the captions “Board of Directors” and “Transactions with Directors, Officers and Affiliates” in our definitive proxy statement for our annual meeting of shareholders to be held on February 23, 2012 is incorporated by reference herein.

Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services.

The information under the caption “Audit Committee and Auditors — Our Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and Audit Fees” in our definitive proxy statement for our annual meeting of shareholders to be held on February 23, 2012 is incorporated by reference herein.

 

129


Table of Contents

PART IV

Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules.

(a) The following documents are filed as a part of this report:

1. Consolidated Financial Statements (see Item 8).

2. Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules.

All schedules have been omitted because they are inapplicable, not required, or the information is included elsewhere in the Consolidated Financial Statements or notes thereto.

3. Exhibits

Those exhibits required to be filed by Item 601 of Regulation S-K are listed in the Index to Exhibits immediately preceding the exhibits filed herewith and such listing is incorporated herein by reference.

 

130


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

NCI BUILDING SYSTEMS, INC.
By:  

/s/  NORMAN C. CHAMBERS        

  Norman C. Chambers, President and
  Chief Executive Officer

Date: December 21, 2011

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated per Form 10-K.

 

Name

  

Title

 

Date

/s/ NORMAN C. CHAMBERS

Norman C. Chambers

   Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)   December 21, 2011

/s/ MARK E. JOHNSON

Mark E. Johnson

   Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer (Principal Financial Officer)   December 21, 2011

/s/ RICHARD ALLEN

Richard Allen

   Vice President — Finance and Chief Accounting Officer (Principal Accounting Officer)   December 21, 2011

*

Kathleen J. Affeldt

   Director   December 21, 2011

*

James G. Berges

   Director   December 21, 2011

*

Gary L. Forbes

   Director   December 21, 2011

*

John J. Holland

   Director   December 21, 2011

*

Lawrence J. Kremer

   Director   December 21, 2011

*

George Martinez

   Director   December 21, 2011

*

Nathan K. Sleeper

   Director   December 21, 2011

*

Jonathan L. Zrebiec

   Director   December 21, 2011

 

*By:  

/s/ NORMAN C.CHAMBERS

  Norman C. Chambers, Attorney-in-Fact

 

131


Table of Contents

Index to Exhibits

 

2.1    Stockholders Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, by and between the Company, Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. and CD&R Friends & Family Fund VIII, L.P. (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.2    Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, by and between the Company, Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. and CD&R Friends & Family Fund VIII, L.P. (filed as Exhibit 2.2 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.3    Indemnification Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, by and between the Company, NCI Group, Inc., Robertson-Ceco II Corporation, Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P., CD&R Friends & Family Fund VIII, L.P. and Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 2.3 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.5    Investment Agreement, dated as of August 14, 2009, by and between NCI Building Systems, Inc. and Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 19, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.6    Amendment, dated as of August 28, 2009, to the Investment Agreement, dated as of August 14, 2009, by and between NCI Building Systems, Inc. and Clayton, Dubilier & Rice Fund VIII, L.P. (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 28, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.7    Amendment No. 2, dated as of August 31, 2009, to the Investment Agreement (as amended), dated as of August 14, 2009, by and between NCI Building Systems, Inc. and Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, Fund VIII, L.P., including exhibits thereto (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed September 1, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.8    Amendment No. 3, dated as of October 8, 2009, to the Investment Agreement (as amended), dated as of August 14, 2009, by and between NCI Building Systems, Inc. and Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, Fund VIII, L.P., including exhibits thereto (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed October 8, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.9    Amendment No. 4, dated as of October 16, 2009, to the Investment Agreement (as amended), dated as of August 14, 2009, by and between NCI Building Systems, Inc. and Clayton, Dubilier & Rice, Fund VIII, L.P., including exhibits thereto (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed October 19, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
2.10    Lock-Up and Voting Agreement, dated as of August 31, 2009, by and among NCI Building Systems, Inc. and the signatories thereto (incorporated by reference to exhibit 2.2 to Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 1, 2009)
2.11    Amendment No. 1 to Lock-Up and Voting Agreement, dated as of October 8, 2009, by and among NCI Building Systems, Inc. and the signatories thereto (incorporated by reference to exhibit 2.3 to Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 8, 2009)
2.12    Lock-Up and Voting Agreement, dated as of October 8, 2009, by and among NCI Building Systems, Inc. and the signatories thereto (incorporated by reference to exhibit 2.2 to Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 8, 2009)
3.1    Restated Certificate of Incorporation, as amended through September 30, 1998 (filed as Exhibit 3.1 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 2, 2002 and incorporated by reference herein)
3.2    Certificate of Amendment to Restated Certificate of Incorporation, effective as of March 12, 2007 (filed as Exhibit 3.2 to NCI’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended April 29, 2007 and incorporated by reference herein)

 

132


Table of Contents
3.3    Certificate of Amendment to Restated Certificate of Incorporation, effective as of March 4, 2010 (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to NCI’s registration statement on Form S-8 filed with the SEC on April 23, 2010 and incorporated by reference herein)
3.4    Second Amended and Restated By-Laws, effective as of October 20, 2009 (filed as Exhibit 3.4 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
3.5    Third Amended and Restated By-laws of NCI Building Systems, Inc., effective as of February 19, 2010 (filed as Exhibit 3.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 24, 2010 and incorporated by reference herein)
3.6    Certificate of Designations, preferences, limitations and relative rights of Series B Cumulative Convertible Participating Preferred Stock of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
3.7    Certificate of Elimination of the Series A Junior Participating Preferred Stock of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3.2 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
3.8    Certificate of Increase of Number of Shares of Series B Cumulative Convertible Participating Preferred Stock of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3.3 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
4.1    Form of certificate representing shares of NCI’s common stock (filed as Exhibit 1 to NCI’s registration statement on Form 8-A filed with the SEC on July 20, 1998 and incorporated by reference herein)
4.2    Credit Agreement, dated June 18, 2004, by and among NCI, certain of its subsidiaries, as guarantors, Wachovia Bank, National Association, as administrative agent, Bank of America, N.A., as syndication agent, and the several lenders named therein (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to NCI’s Form 10-Q/A, filed with the SEC on September 16, 2004, amending its quarterly report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended July 31, 2004 and incorporated by reference herein)
4.3    First Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of November 9, 2004, between NCI Building Systems, Inc, as borrower, certain of its subsidiaries, as guarantors, Wachovia National Bank, National Association, as administrative agent and lender, and the several lenders named therein (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 16, 2004 and incorporated by reference herein)
4.4    Second Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of October 14, 2005, between NCI Building Systems, Inc, as borrower, certain of its subsidiaries, as guarantors, Wachovia National Bank, National Association, as administrative agent and lender, and the several lenders named therein (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 14, 2005 and incorporated by reference herein)
4.5    Third Amendment, dated April 7, 2006, to Credit Agreement, dated June 18, 2004, by and among NCI Building Systems, Inc. as borrower, certain of its subsidiaries, as guarantors, Wachovia Bank, National Association, as administrative agent and lender, and the several lenders parties thereto (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated April 7, 2006 and incorporated by reference herein)
4.6    Indenture, dated November 16, 2004, by and among NCI, and The Bank of New York (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 16, 2004 and incorporated by reference herein)
4.7    Amended Credit Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, among the Company, as borrower, Wachovia Bank, National Association, as administrative agent and collateral agent and the several lenders party thereto (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)

 

133


Table of Contents
    4.8    Loan and Security Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, by and among NCI Group, Inc. and Robertson-Ceco II Corporation, as borrowers, the Company and Steelbuilding.Com, Inc., as guarantors, Wells Fargo Foothill, LLC, as administrative and co-collateral agent, Bank of America, N.A. and General Electric Capital Corporation, as co-collateral agents and the lenders and issuing bank party thereto (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
    4.9    Amendment No. 1 to Loan and Security Agreement, dated December 3, 2010, by and among the Company, as borrower or guarantor, certain domestic subsidiaries of the Company, as borrowers or guarantors, Wells Fargo Capital Finance, LLC, as administrative agent and co-collateral agent (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 9, 2010 and incorporated by reference herein)
    4.10    Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, by and among the Company, as borrower or guarantor, certain domestic subsidiaries of the Company, as borrowers or guarantors, Wachovia Bank, National Association, as term loan agent and term loan administrative agent, Wells Fargo Foothill, LLC, as working capital agent and working capital administrative agent and Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as control agent (filed as Exhibit 10.3 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
    4.11    Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009 by the Company and certain of its subsidiaries in favor of Wachovia Bank, National Association as administrative agent and collateral agent (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
    4.12    Guaranty Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009 by NCI Group, Inc., Robertson-Ceco II Corporation, the Company and Steelbuilding.com, Inc., in favor of Wells Fargo Foothill, LLC as administrative agent and collateral agent (filed as Exhibit 10.5 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
    4.13    Pledge and Security Agreement, dated as of October 20, 2009, by and among the Company, NCI Group, Inc. and Robertson-Ceco II Corporation, to and in favor of Wells Fargo Foothill, LLC in its capacity as administrative agent and collateral agent (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.1    Employment Agreement, dated April 12, 2004, among the Company, NCI Group, L.P. and Norman C. Chambers (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended May 1, 2004 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.2    Amendment Agreement, dated August 14, 2009, among the Company, NCI Group, L.P. and Norman C. Chambers (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal ended November 1, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
*10.3    Amended and Restated Bonus Program, as amended and restated as of December 5, 2011
†10.4    Stock Option Plan, as amended and restated on December 14, 2000 (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 31, 2000 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.5    Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.5 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 31, 2000 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.6    2003 Long-Term Stock Incentive Plan, as amended and restated March 12, 2009 (filed as Annex A to NCI’s Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting held March 12, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.7    Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to NCI’s registration statement no. 333-111139 and incorporated by reference herein)

 

134


Table of Contents
†10.8    Form of Incentive Stock Option Agreement (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to NCI’s registration statement no. 333-111139 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.9    Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement for Senior Executive Officers (Electronic) (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 7, 2006 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.10    Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement for Key Employees (filed as Exhibit 10.3 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 7, 2006 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.11    Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 7, 2006 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.12    Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement for Non-Employee Directors (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 23, 2006 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.13    Restricted Stock Agreement, dated April 26, 2004, between NCI and Norman C. Chambers (filed as exhibit 10.2 to NCI’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended May 1, 2004 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.14    First Amendment, dated October 24, 2005, to Restricted Stock Agreement, dated April 26, 2004, between NCI and Norman C. Chambers (filed as Exhibit 10.21 to NCI’s Annual Report on
Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 29, 2005 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.15    Restricted Stock Agreement, effective August 26, 2004, between NCI and Mark Dobbins (filed as Exhibit 10.15 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal ended November 1, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.16    Restricted Stock Agreement, effective August 26, 2004 between NCI and Charles Dickinson (filed as Exhibit 10.16 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal ended November 1, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.17    Amended and Restated NCI Building Systems, Inc. Deferred Compensation Plan (as amended and restated effective January 1, 2007) (filed as Exhibit 10.23 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 29, 2006 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.18    First Amendment to the NCI Building Systems, Inc. Deferred Compensation Plan (as amended and restated effective October 20, 2009) (filed as Exhibit 10.18 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal ended November 1, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.19    Form of Employment Agreement between NCI and executive officers (filed as Exhibit 10.25 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 28, 2007 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.20    Form of Amendment Agreement, dated August 14, 2009, among the Company, NCI Group, L.P. and executive officers (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to NCI’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal ended November 1, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.21    Form of Indemnification Agreement for Officers and Directors (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 22, 2008 and incorporated by reference herein)
†10.22    Form of Director Indemnification Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.7 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 26, 2009 and incorporated by reference herein)
  10.23    Mutual Waiver and Consent (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended July 31, 2011 and incorporated by reference herein)
  10.24    Mutual Waiver and Consent (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to NCI’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 12, 2011 and incorporated by reference herein)

 

135


Table of Contents

      *21.1

   List of Subsidiaries

      *23.1

   Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

      *24.1

   Powers of Attorney

      *31.1

   Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certifications (Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002)

      *31.2

   Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certifications (Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002)

    **32.1

   Certifications pursuant to Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code (Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002)

    **32.2

   Certifications pursuant to Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code (Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002)

  **101.INS

   XBRL Instance Document

  **101.SCH

   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

  **101.CAL

   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document

  **101.DEF

   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document

  **101.LAB

   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Labels Linkbase Document

  **101.PRE

   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

 

* Filed herewith
** Furnished herewith
Management contracts or compensatory plans or arrangements

 

136